Sie sind auf Seite 1von 271

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System V100R002C01

Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management


Issue Date 02 2010-09-24

HUAWEI TECHNOLOGIES CO., LTD.

Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2010. All rights reserved. No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written consent of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Trademarks and Permissions


and other Huawei trademarks are trademarks of Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. All other trademarks and trade names mentioned in this document are the property of their respective holders.

Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and the customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be within the purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements, information, and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees or representations of any kind, either express or implied. The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and recommendations in this document do not constitute the warranty of any kind, express or implied.

Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.


Address: Huawei Industrial Base Bantian, Longgang Shenzhen 518129 People's Republic of China http://www.huawei.com support@huawei.com

Website: Email:

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

About This Document

About This Document


Related Version
The following table lists the product version related to this document. Product Name iManager U2000 Version V100R002C01

Intended Audience
This document describes the procedures and operations, such as how to configure and maintain the SDH ASON network. This document also provide the timeslot numbering policy, the glossary, and the acronyms and abbreviations. This document is intended for: l l l l Network Monitoring Engineer Data Configuration Engineer NM Administrator System Maintenance Engineer

Symbol Conventions
The symbols that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Symbol Description

DANGER

Indicates a hazard with a high level of risk, which if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury. Indicates a hazard with a medium or low level of risk, which if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.

WARNING
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iii

About This Document

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Symbol

Description

CAUTION
TIP

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation, which if not avoided, could result in equipment damage, data loss, performance degradation, or unexpected results. Indicates a tip that may help you solve a problem or save time. Provides additional information to emphasize or supplement important points of the main text.

NOTE

Command Conventions
The command conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Convention Boldface Italic [] { x | y | ... } [ x | y | ... ] { x | y | ... }* Description The keywords of a command line are in boldface. Command arguments are in italics. Items (keywords or arguments) in brackets [ ] are optional. Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. One item is selected. Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by vertical bars. One item is selected or no item is selected. Optional items are grouped in braces and separated by vertical bars. A minimum of one item or a maximum of all items can be selected. Optional items are grouped in brackets and separated by vertical bars. Several items or no item can be selected.

[ x | y | ... ]*

GUI Conventions
The GUI conventions that may be found in this document are defined as follows. Convention Boldface > Description Buttons, menus, parameters, tabs, window, and dialog titles are in boldface. For example, click OK. Multi-level menus are in boldface and separated by the ">" signs. For example, choose File > Create > Folder.

iv

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

About This Document

Update History
Updates between document versions are cumulative. Therefore, the latest document version contains all updates made to previous versions.

Updates in Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Based on Product Version V100R002C01


The second release of the iManager U2000 V100R002C01. Some bugs in the manual of the previous version are fixed.

Updates in Issue 01 (2010-08-16) Based on Product Version V100R002C01


The first release of the iManager U2000 V100R002C01.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Contents

Contents
About This Document...................................................................................................................iii 1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks.......................................................................................1-1
1.1 SDH ASON Network Configuration...............................................................................................................1-4 1.2 ASON..............................................................................................................................................................1-5 1.2.1 Basic Concepts of ASON.......................................................................................................................1-6 1.2.2 Function Structure of the ASON............................................................................................................1-8 1.2.3 ASON Protocol....................................................................................................................................1-11 1.2.4 ASON Links.........................................................................................................................................1-13 1.2.5 SLA......................................................................................................................................................1-14 1.2.6 Diamond Services................................................................................................................................1-16 1.2.7 Gold Services.......................................................................................................................................1-21 1.2.8 Silver Services......................................................................................................................................1-23 1.2.9 Copper Services....................................................................................................................................1-25 1.2.10 Iron Services.......................................................................................................................................1-26 1.2.11 OVPN.................................................................................................................................................1-27 1.2.12 UNI Services......................................................................................................................................1-29 1.3 Creating an ASON Topology........................................................................................................................1-31 1.3.1 Creating NEs in Batches......................................................................................................................1-33 1.3.2 Creating a Single NE............................................................................................................................1-35 1.3.3 Setting the Node ID..............................................................................................................................1-36 1.3.4 Enabling the ASON Feature ................................................................................................................1-37 1.3.5 Uploading NE Configuration Data.......................................................................................................1-38 1.3.6 Enable the ASON Feature of a Board..................................................................................................1-39 1.3.7 Creating Domains for an ASON Network...........................................................................................1-39 1.3.8 Synchronizing ASON NEs...................................................................................................................1-40 1.3.9 Automatically Creating Fibers According to TE Link.........................................................................1-41 1.3.10 Setting the Primary NE or Secondary NE..........................................................................................1-42 1.3.11 Setting Control Plane Parameters.......................................................................................................1-42 1.3.12 Viewing ASON NE Software Version...............................................................................................1-44 1.4 Managing the ASON Protocol......................................................................................................................1-44 1.4.1 Modifying the LMP Discovery Type...................................................................................................1-46 1.4.2 Querying the LMP Discovery Type.....................................................................................................1-47 1.4.3 Disabling the LMP Protocol.................................................................................................................1-48 Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. vii

Contents

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management 1.4.4 Disabling the OSPF Protocol...............................................................................................................1-49 1.4.5 Encrypting the OSPF Protocol.............................................................................................................1-50 1.4.6 Setting the OSPF TE Link Flood Threshold........................................................................................1-50 1.4.7 Encrypting RSVP.................................................................................................................................1-51 1.4.8 Creating Out-Fiber Control Channels..................................................................................................1-52

1.5 Managing ASON Clock Subnet....................................................................................................................1-54 1.5.1 Creating an ASON Clock Subnet.........................................................................................................1-54 1.5.2 Converting a Preconfigured ASON Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet................................1-57 1.5.3 Converting a Traditional Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet.................................................1-61 1.5.4 Managing a Hybrid Network Composed of an ASON Clock Subnet and a Traditional Clock Subnet .......................................................................................................................................................................1-64 1.5.5 Setting the Clock Fault Recover Time.................................................................................................1-67 1.6 Managing Link Resources.............................................................................................................................1-67 1.6.1 Synchronizing Control Links Networkwide........................................................................................1-69 1.6.2 Synchronizing TE Links.......................................................................................................................1-69 1.6.3 Viewing TE Links................................................................................................................................1-70 1.6.4 Configuring the Link Distance.............................................................................................................1-71 1.6.5 Setting the Custom Cost of the TE Link .............................................................................................1-71 1.6.6 Setting the Usage Threshold of Fiber Resources.................................................................................1-72 1.6.7 Creating an SRLG................................................................................................................................1-72 1.6.8 Querying VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status.........................................................................................1-73 1.6.9 Querying the Information About the Timeslots on the Link Sections.................................................1-74 1.6.10 Setting Resource Reservation.............................................................................................................1-75 1.6.11 Creating a Virtual Interfaces..............................................................................................................1-77 1.6.12 Creating a Virtual TE Link.................................................................................................................1-78 1.6.13 Creating a TE Link Based on Virtual Interfaces................................................................................1-80 1.6.14 Deleting an Interrupted TE Link Manually........................................................................................1-84 1.7 Managing SRGs............................................................................................................................................1-85 1.7.1 Creating an SRG...................................................................................................................................1-85 1.7.2 Querying the SRG Related to a TE Link..............................................................................................1-89 1.7.3 Querying the SRG Related to an ASON NE........................................................................................1-89 1.8 Creating ASON Services...............................................................................................................................1-90 1.8.1 Synchronizing ASON Trails................................................................................................................1-91 1.8.2 Creating a Diamond ASON Service.....................................................................................................1-92 1.8.3 Creating a Gold ASON service............................................................................................................1-96 1.8.4 Creating a Silver ASON Service........................................................................................................1-100 1.8.5 Creating a Copper ASON Service......................................................................................................1-104 1.8.6 Creating an Iron ASON Service.........................................................................................................1-107 1.8.7 Creating an ASON Server Trail.........................................................................................................1-111 1.8.8 Creating a Segmented ASON Server Trail........................................................................................1-115 1.8.9 Creating Two Associated SDH ASON Trails....................................................................................1-118 1.8.10 Setting ASON Trail Association......................................................................................................1-120 1.8.11 Creating ASON Services in Batches................................................................................................1-121 viii Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Contents

1.8.12 Deactivating the SDH ASON Trail..................................................................................................1-125 1.8.13 Deleting an ASON Trail...................................................................................................................1-126 1.9 Modifying the Attributes of ASON Services..............................................................................................1-127 1.9.1 Viewing ASON Service Attributes....................................................................................................1-127 1.9.2 Setting the Routing Attributes............................................................................................................1-129 1.9.3 Setting the Scheduled Reversion Time..............................................................................................1-129 1.9.4 Setting the B3 Alarm to Trigger Rerouting........................................................................................1-130 1.9.5 Setting Preset Restoration Trail..........................................................................................................1-131 1.9.6 Setting Shared MESH Restoration Trail............................................................................................1-132 1.9.7 Setting the Original Route..................................................................................................................1-133 1.10 Modifying the Route of an ASON Service...............................................................................................1-133 1.10.1 Reverting ASON Trails....................................................................................................................1-134 1.10.2 Optimizing an ASON Service..........................................................................................................1-135 1.11 Migrating ASON Services........................................................................................................................1-136 1.11.1 Downgrading an ASON Service to a Traditional Service................................................................1-136 1.11.2 Upgrading a Traditional Service to an ASON Service.....................................................................1-137 1.11.3 Migration Between ASON Services................................................................................................1-138 1.11.4 Downgrading an ASON Server Trail to a Traditional Server Trail.................................................1-139 1.11.5 Upgrading a Traditional Server Trail to an ASON Server Trail......................................................1-140 1.11.6 Migration Between ASON Server Trails.........................................................................................1-141 1.12 Creating ASON Trail Groups....................................................................................................................1-142 1.13 Creating Services Between an ASON NE and a Traditional NE..............................................................1-145 1.13.1 Creating a VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain...........................1-145 1.13.2 Creating a VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain.........................1-149 1.13.3 Creating a VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE...........................................1-152 1.13.4 Creating a VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE.........................................1-156 1.13.5 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE..................................1-159 1.13.6 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE....................................1-164 1.13.7 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain................1-170 1.13.8 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain..................1-174 1.14 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Through Linear MSP......................................................1-178 1.15 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Network by Using the SNCP Accessed Service.............1-182 1.15.1 Creating the SNCP Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE......................................1-182 1.15.2 Creating SNCP Services Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain........................1-187 1.15.3 Querying the Information About the SNCP Accessed Service........................................................1-193 1.15.4 Performing Switching at the SNCP Access End..............................................................................1-193 1.16 Managing UNI Services............................................................................................................................1-194 1.16.1 Flow of Configuring UNI Services..................................................................................................1-195 1.16.2 Enabling the UNI Feature of an ASON NE.....................................................................................1-196 1.16.3 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI ............................................................................1-197 1.16.4 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI ...................................................................................1-200 1.16.5 Setting the UNI Access Policy.........................................................................................................1-202 Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. ix

Contents

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management 1.16.6 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI Link.....................................................................1-203 1.16.7 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI Link............................................................................1-204 1.16.8 Querying UNI Services....................................................................................................................1-205 1.16.9 Deleting UNI Services.....................................................................................................................1-206

1.17 Managing the OVPN Customers and OVPN Services..............................................................................1-207 1.17.1 Enabling OVPN Function of ASON NE..........................................................................................1-208 1.17.2 Creating NM User for OVPN Customer..........................................................................................1-208 1.17.3 Creating an OVPN Customer...........................................................................................................1-210 1.17.4 Allocating TE Links for OVPN Customers.....................................................................................1-212 1.17.5 Creating OVPN Services..................................................................................................................1-213 1.17.6 Querying the TE Link Resources of the OVPN Customers.............................................................1-216 1.17.7 Querying the Services of the OVPN Customers..............................................................................1-217 1.18 Importing and Exporting Data...................................................................................................................1-218 1.18.1 Exporting Data from U2000 to MDS...............................................................................................1-218 1.18.2 Importing Data from MDS to U2000...............................................................................................1-219 1.19 Managing Control Plane Alarms and Performance Events.......................................................................1-220 1.19.1 Querying Control Plane Alarms.......................................................................................................1-221 1.19.2 Setting the Severity of Control Plane Alarm....................................................................................1-221 1.19.3 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Alarm............................................................1-222 1.19.4 Suppressing Control Plane Alarms..................................................................................................1-222 1.19.5 Suppressing Control Plane Alarm Events........................................................................................1-223 1.19.6 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane..............................................................................1-223 1.19.7 Monitoring the Control Plane Performance.....................................................................................1-224 1.19.8 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Performance Data.........................................1-225 1.19.9 Setting the Control Plane Performance Threshold ..........................................................................1-226

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network......................................................................2-1


2.1 Precautions for Routine Maintenance.............................................................................................................2-2 2.2 Routine Maintenance Items.............................................................................................................................2-3 2.2.1 Periodically Refreshing the ASON information....................................................................................2-4 2.2.2 Querying Network-Wide Alarms...........................................................................................................2-4 2.2.3 Querying ASON Trail Alarms...............................................................................................................2-5 2.2.4 Querying Control Plane Alarms.............................................................................................................2-6 2.2.5 Querying Control Link Alarms..............................................................................................................2-7 2.2.6 Querying TE Link Alarms......................................................................................................................2-7 2.2.7 Creating a Performance Filtering Template...........................................................................................2-8 2.2.8 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane....................................................................................2-8 2.2.9 Querying Abnormal ASON Events........................................................................................................2-9 2.2.10 Checking the Running Status of ASON Trails...................................................................................2-10 2.2.11 Checking TE Links.............................................................................................................................2-12 2.2.12 Checking Control Links.....................................................................................................................2-13 2.2.13 Checking the Activation Status of ASON Services...........................................................................2-13

3 Handling ASON Network Failures........................................................................................3-1


x Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Contents

3.1 Handling Link Failures....................................................................................................................................3-2 3.1.1 Handling Impassable Control Channels.................................................................................................3-2 3.1.2 Handling Impassable Component Links................................................................................................3-3 3.1.3 Handling Impassable TE Links..............................................................................................................3-3 3.1.4 Handling Downgraded TE Links........................................................................................................... 3-4 3.2 Handling the Failure in Creating Trails...........................................................................................................3-4 3.2.1 Handling the Failure of Route Computation..........................................................................................3-5 3.2.2 Handling the Failure to Allocate Labels................................................................................................ 3-6 3.2.3 Handling the Failure in Creating Services in Batches............................................................................3-6 3.3 Handling Trail Interruption.............................................................................................................................3-7 3.3.1 Determining Interrupted Services.......................................................................................................... 3-7 3.3.2 Troubleshooting Interruption of Services.............................................................................................. 3-8 3.4 Disaster Recovery........................................................................................................................................... 3-8

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xi

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figures

Figures
Figure 1-1 Three planes of the ASON..................................................................................................................1-6 Figure 1-2 Function structure of the ASON.........................................................................................................1-9 Figure 1-3 ASON NE...........................................................................................................................................1-9 Figure 1-4 Creating control channels.................................................................................................................1-11 Figure 1-5 Verifying component links and TE links..........................................................................................1-12 Figure 1-6 Diamond Services.............................................................................................................................1-17 Figure 1-7 Gold services....................................................................................................................................1-21 Figure 1-8 A silver service.................................................................................................................................1-23 Figure 1-9 Networking diagram of an OVPN....................................................................................................1-27 Figure 1-10 Allocating TE links.........................................................................................................................1-28 Figure 1-11 Ethernet UNI services.....................................................................................................................1-30 Figure 1-12 SDH UNI services..........................................................................................................................1-31 Figure 1-13 LMP discovery mode......................................................................................................................1-46 Figure 1-14 Board configuration of NE3 and NE4............................................................................................1-47 Figure 1-15 Creating out-fiber control channels................................................................................................1-52 Figure 1-16 ASON clock subnet........................................................................................................................1-55 Figure 1-17 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4...............................................................................................1-56 Figure 1-18 Traditional Clock Subnet................................................................................................................1-58 Figure 1-19 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4...............................................................................................1-58 Figure 1-20 ASON clock subnet........................................................................................................................1-61 Figure 1-21 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4...............................................................................................1-62 Figure 1-22 Hybrid network composed of an ASON clock subnet and a traditional clock subnet...................1-65 Figure 1-23 Board configuration of NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4..........................................................................1-65 Figure 1-24 SRLG schematic diagram...............................................................................................................1-73 Figure 1-25 Reserved link resources..................................................................................................................1-75 Figure 1-26 Board configurations on NE3 and NE4..........................................................................................1-76 Figure 1-27 Virtual TE link................................................................................................................................1-78 Figure 1-28 Board configuration for NE3 and NE4...........................................................................................1-79 Figure 1-29 Board configuration for NE5..........................................................................................................1-79 Figure 1-30 TE link based on virtual interfaces.................................................................................................1-81 Figure 1-31 Board configuration for NE1 and NE4...........................................................................................1-82 Figure 1-32 Board configuration for virtual NEs...............................................................................................1-82 Figure 1-33 Schematic diagram of the physical topology of an SRG................................................................1-86 Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xiii

Figures

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management Figure 1-34 Schematic diagram of the topology of the TE links in an SRG......................................................1-86 Figure 1-35 Diamond service requirement.........................................................................................................1-92 Figure 1-36 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3...........................................................................................1-93 Figure 1-37 Gold service requirement................................................................................................................1-97 Figure 1-38 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3...........................................................................................1-97 Figure 1-39 Silver service requirement............................................................................................................1-101

Figure 1-40 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3.........................................................................................1-101 Figure 1-41 Copper service requirement..........................................................................................................1-104 Figure 1-42 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3.........................................................................................1-105 Figure 1-43 Iron service requirement...............................................................................................................1-108 Figure 1-44 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3.........................................................................................1-108 Figure 1-45 Diamond ASON server trail requirement.....................................................................................1-111 Figure 1-46 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3.........................................................................................1-112 Figure 1-47 Segmented ASON server trail requirement..................................................................................1-115 Figure 1-48 Board configuration for NE1-NE3...............................................................................................1-116 Figure 1-49 Two associated ASON trails ........................................................................................................1-118 Figure 1-50 Batch silver service requirement..................................................................................................1-122 Figure 1-51 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3.........................................................................................1-122 Figure 1-52 ASON trail group service requirement.........................................................................................1-142 Figure 1-53 Board configuration of NE1 and NE3..........................................................................................1-143 Figure 1-54 Board configuration of NE2 and NE4..........................................................................................1-143 Figure 1-55 VC4 service requirement between traditional NEs......................................................................1-146 Figure 1-56 Board configuration for NE1-NE4...............................................................................................1-146 Figure 1-57 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6.........................................................................................1-147 Figure 1-58 VC12 service requirement between traditional NEs....................................................................1-149 Figure 1-59 Board configuration for NE1-NE4...............................................................................................1-150 Figure 1-60 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6.........................................................................................1-150 Figure 1-61 VC4 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs....................................................1-152 Figure 1-62 Board configuration for NE1........................................................................................................1-153 Figure 1-63 Board configuration for NE2-NE4...............................................................................................1-153 Figure 1-64 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6.........................................................................................1-154 Figure 1-65 VC12 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs..................................................1-156 Figure 1-66 Board configuration for NE1-NE4...............................................................................................1-157 Figure 1-67 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6.........................................................................................1-157 Figure 1-68 1+1 VC12 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs..........................................1-160 Figure 1-69 Board configuration for NE1-NE4...............................................................................................1-160 Figure 1-70 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6.........................................................................................1-161 Figure 1-71 1+1 VC4 service requirement between a traditional NE and an ASON NE................................1-165 Figure 1-72 Board configuration of NE1-NE4.................................................................................................1-165 Figure 1-73 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6..........................................................................................1-166 Figure 1-74 1+1 VC12 service requirement between traditional NEs.............................................................1-170 Figure 1-75 Board configuration of NE1-NE4.................................................................................................1-171 xiv Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figures

Figure 1-76 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6..........................................................................................1-171 Figure 1-77 1+1 VC4 service requirement between traditional NEs...............................................................1-175 Figure 1-78 Board configuration of NE1-NE4.................................................................................................1-175 Figure 1-79 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6..........................................................................................1-176 Figure 1-80 Accessing 1+1 linear MSP...........................................................................................................1-179 Figure 1-81 Board configuration of NE1 and NE4..........................................................................................1-179 Figure 1-82 Board configuration of NE2 and NE3..........................................................................................1-180 Figure 1-83 Board configuration of NE5.........................................................................................................1-180 Figure 1-84 SNCP service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE.........................................................1-183 Figure 1-85 Board configuration of NE1-NE4.................................................................................................1-183 Figure 1-86 Board configuration of NE5-NE7.................................................................................................1-184 Figure 1-87 SNCP services between traditional NEs that cross the ASON domain........................................1-188 Figure 1-88 Board configuration of NE1-NE4.................................................................................................1-188 Figure 1-89 Board configuration of NE5-NE10...............................................................................................1-189 Figure 1-90 Flow of configuring UNI services................................................................................................1-196 Figure 1-91 Setting the information about the GMPLS UNI ..........................................................................1-198 Figure 1-92 Board configuration of NE1.........................................................................................................1-198 Figure 1-93 Board configuration of NE3.........................................................................................................1-199 Figure 1-94 Setting the information about the OIF UNI .................................................................................1-200 Figure 1-95 Board configuration of NE1.........................................................................................................1-201 Figure 1-96 Board configuration of NE3.........................................................................................................1-201 Figure 1-97 OVPN service requirements.........................................................................................................1-214 Figure 1-98 Board configuration of NE1 and NE3..........................................................................................1-214

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

xv

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Tables

Tables
Table 1-1 Service level.......................................................................................................................................1-15 Table 1-2 TE links used by ASON services.......................................................................................................1-15 Table 1-3 Attributes of the permanent 1+1 diamond services............................................................................1-17 Table 1-4 Attributes of the rerouting 1+1 diamond service...............................................................................1-19 Table 1-5 Attributes of the non-rerouting 1+1 diamond service........................................................................1-20 Table 1-6 Attributes of gold services.................................................................................................................1-21 Table 1-7 Attributes of silver services................................................................................................................1-24 Table 1-8 Attributes of copper services..............................................................................................................1-25 Table 1-9 Attributes of iron services..................................................................................................................1-26 Table 1-10 OVPN service attributes...................................................................................................................1-29 Table 1-11 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4................................................................................................1-56 Table 1-12 Planning for the new clock subnet...................................................................................................1-59 Table 1-13 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4................................................................................................1-62 Table 1-14 Clock subnet planning......................................................................................................................1-66 Table 1-15 Virtual interface planning................................................................................................................1-82 Table 1-16 Virtual TE link planning..................................................................................................................1-83 Table 1-17 Risk cause analysis...........................................................................................................................1-87 Table 1-18 SRGs for pipes.................................................................................................................................1-87 Table 1-19 SRGs for optical cables....................................................................................................................1-87 Table 1-20 SRGs for NEs...................................................................................................................................1-88 Table 1-21 SRGs for sites...................................................................................................................................1-88 Table 1-22 Diamond service planning................................................................................................................1-93 Table 1-23 Gold service planning......................................................................................................................1-97 Table 1-24 Silver service planning...................................................................................................................1-101 Table 1-25 Copper service planning.................................................................................................................1-105 Table 1-26 Iron service planning......................................................................................................................1-108 Table 1-27 Diamond ASON server trail planning............................................................................................1-112 Table 1-28 Silver ASON server trail planning.................................................................................................1-116 Table 1-29 VC12 service planning on NE1, NE2 and NE...............................................................................1-117 Table 1-30 Silver service planning...................................................................................................................1-123 Table 1-31 GE service planning.......................................................................................................................1-144 Table 1-32 VC4 service planning between traditional NEs.............................................................................1-147 Table 1-33 VC12 service planning between traditional NEs...........................................................................1-151 Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. xvii

Tables

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management Table 1-34 VC4 service planning between traditional NE and ASON NE......................................................1-154 Table 1-35 Silver ASON server trail planning.................................................................................................1-158 Table 1-36 VC12 service planning for NE1, NE4 and NE5............................................................................1-158 Table 1-37 Service planning for double silver ASON server trails..................................................................1-161 Table 1-38 SNCP service planning for NE5....................................................................................................1-161 Table 1-39 SNCP service planning for NE1....................................................................................................1-162 Table 1-40 Service planning for NE3 and NE4................................................................................................1-163 Table 1-41 Service planning for the two silver ASON trails...........................................................................1-166 Table 1-42 SNCP service planning for NE5....................................................................................................1-166 Table 1-43 SNCP service planning for NE1....................................................................................................1-167 Table 1-44 Service planning for NE3 and NE4................................................................................................1-167 Table 1-45 Planning of two silver ASON trails...............................................................................................1-172 Table 1-46 SNCP service planning of NE5......................................................................................................1-172 Table 1-47 SNCP service planning of NE6......................................................................................................1-173 Table 1-48 Planning of Two Silver ASON Trails............................................................................................1-176 Table 1-49 SNCP service planning of NE5......................................................................................................1-177 Table 1-50 SNCP service planning of NE6......................................................................................................1-177 Table 1-51 Planning of Diamond Services Accessed Through 1+1 Linear MSP............................................1-181 Table 1-52 Planning of the diamond service between NE1 and NE3..............................................................1-184 Table 1-53 SNCP service planning for NE1 and NE5.....................................................................................1-185 Table 1-54 Service planning for NE6 and NE7................................................................................................1-185 Table 1-55 Planning of the diamond service between NE1 and NE3..............................................................1-189 Table 1-56 SNCP service planning for NE1, NE3, NE5, and NE9..................................................................1-190 Table 1-57 Service planning for NE6, NE7, NE8, and NE10..........................................................................1-190 Table 1-58 OVPN service planning..................................................................................................................1-215 Table 2-1 Abnormal Events List........................................................................................................................2-10

xviii

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Configuring SDH ASON Networks

About This Chapter


You can configure an ASON network using the U2000. 1.1 SDH ASON Network Configuration This section describes how to configure an ASON network on the U2000. 1.2 ASON The automatically switched optical network (ASON) is a new generation optical transmission network. An ASON NE refers to the equipment that has ASON features. An ASON NE also has the features of traditional SDH NEs besides the ASON features. The U2000 manages the ASON network by integrating the ASON features with the SDH features. 1.3 Creating an ASON Topology The ASON network uses the route protocol to create the topology information of the nodes in the network so that each node can obtain a networkwide topology. The U2000 can discover other ASON NEs in the network from any ASON NE. 1.4 Managing the ASON Protocol After the ASON software is enabled, the default ASON protocols are configured for the NE. After the ASON topology is created, you can set again the ASON protocols you need to facilitate the management of ASON link resources and ASON services. 1.5 Managing ASON Clock Subnet Clock subnet is classified into ASON clock subnet and traditional clock subnet. Before configuring ASON services, you need to create a clock subnet to ensure that a consistent clock tracing relation is created for all NEs in the ASON network. 1.6 Managing Link Resources ASON is capable of automatically switching optical network connections under the control of the signaling network. It dynamically allocates network resources as required. As the network is growing larger, a more reasonable way of resource management is required to make the most of the network resources and to improve the network efficiency. Link resource management is one aspect of resource management. In an actual network, thousands of connections may exist between two nodes, while each connection may be composed of multiple data links. Usually, there are links that have the same attributes according to a route protocol. These links are regarded as a whole, which is known as the traffic engineer link (TE link), serving as the processing object of the route information.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-1

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.7 Managing SRGs The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. You can find a balance point between management costs and risk control, determine the risks to be managed, and manage the risks by means of SRGs. 1.8 Creating ASON Services The trail levels that an ASON trail supports are as follows: diamond, gold, silver, copper and iron. The trail levels that an ASON server trail supports are as follows: gold, silver and copper. A label switched path (LSP) is a trail passed through by an ASON service. It is also called an ASON trail. 1.9 Modifying the Attributes of ASON Services As an ASON network is changing, you need to modify the attributes of ASON services in the network according to different ASON features. This facilitates the configuration, management and maintenance of the ASON network. 1.10 Modifying the Route of an ASON Service As an ASON network is changing, you need to modify the route of an ASON service in the network according to different situations. This facilitates the configuration, management and maintenance of the ASON network. 1.11 Migrating ASON Services An ASON network supports the migration between traditional services and ASON services, and supports the in-service migration between ASON services at different levels. 1.12 Creating ASON Trail Groups An ASON trail group is often used with LCAS. 1.13 Creating Services Between an ASON NE and a Traditional NE A network can consist of ASON NEs and traditional NEs. This realizes end-to-end service configuration and management. 1.14 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Through Linear MSP When accessing services from a traditional network, to ensure that reliability of the accessed services, you can create a 1+1 or 1:1 linear MSP at the edge of the traditional network and an ASON domain. You can configure services in an ASON domain to the diamond , gold, and silver level. 1.15 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Network by Using the SNCP Accessed Service When a traditional network is accessed to an ASON network by using the SNCP accessed service, the end-to-end SNCP is implemented for the service. 1.16 Managing UNI Services The UNI is the standard interface that is used to connect the client equipment to the transport network. When the UNI is used, the client equipment can dynamically request transport resources from the transport network and release transport resources to the transport network, by using the control signalling. Configuring UNI services is simpler and takes less time than configuring traditional services. UNI services improve the reliability and real-time performance of the transport network so that burst data service requirements can be met and end-to-end UNI services can be realized. 1.17 Managing the OVPN Customers and OVPN Services In the case of the OVPN, an ASON network is shared by multiple operators. When multiple operators need to share an ASON network, you can allocate different TE link resources for each operator. Each operator can use and manage its own TE link resources and ASON services. 1.18 Importing and Exporting Data
1-2 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

The existing ASON network may not be optimum, so we can use the OptiX Modeling and Design System (MDS) to optimize the network. You can import the ASON data on the U2000 to the MDS, and use the MDS to plan the imported ASON data and work out the optimum solution. You can import a better planning scheme to the U2000. Then, use the U2000 to apply the settings to NEs to optimize the existing ASON network. 1.19 Managing Control Plane Alarms and Performance Events Users can suppress the control plane alarms, monitor the control plane performance, set the autoreport status of the control plane performance, and set the control plane performance threshold based on actual requirements.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-3

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.1 SDH ASON Network Configuration


This section describes how to configure an ASON network on the U2000. To configure an ASON network, the traditional network must run normally, and the ASON software must be enabled and runs normally after commissioning. For details about the commissioning and planning of an ASON network, refer to the ASON User Guide. To configure an ASON network by using the U2000, do as follows: Step 1 Description Create a GNE Remarks Create the ASON NE connected with the U2000 as a GNE. Upload data to the U2000 to ensure that the data on the U2000 is consistent with that on the NE. Create an ASON domain and assign the ASON NEs that belong to the same ASON network to the ASON domain. To improve the reliability, another NE can be set as the standby of the primary NE. Synchronize data networkwide. The U2000 searches for ASON NEs and displays them in the topology view. The U2000 can create fibers between NEs according to the TE links. A more reasonable way of resource management is required to make the most of the network resources and to improve the network efficiency. The U2000 provides the endto-end ASON trail management feature. View alarms and abnormal events.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Uploading NE Configuration Data

Creating Domains for an ASON Network

Setting the Primary NE or Secondary NE Synchronizing ASON NEs

Automatically Creating Fibers According to TE Link Managing Link Resources

Creating ASON Services

Routine Maintenance Items


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-4

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.2 ASON
The automatically switched optical network (ASON) is a new generation optical transmission network. An ASON NE refers to the equipment that has ASON features. An ASON NE also has the features of traditional SDH NEs besides the ASON features. The U2000 manages the ASON network by integrating the ASON features with the SDH features. 1.2.1 Basic Concepts of ASON The basic concepts related to the ASON are the three planes, label switched path (LSP) and rerouting. 1.2.2 Function Structure of the ASON An ASON network consists of ASON NEs, TE links, domains and SPC (soft permanent connections). 1.2.3 ASON Protocol Huawei OptiX GCP applies the link management protocol (LMP) as the link management protocol, OSPF-TE as the routing protocol, and RSVP-TE as the signaling protocol. 1.2.4 ASON Links ASON Links include control channels, control links, component links and TE links. 1.2.5 SLA The ASON network can provide services of different QoS to different clients. 1.2.6 Diamond Services Diamond services have the best protection ability. When there are enough resources in the network, diamond services provide a permanent 1+1 protection. Diamond services are applicable to voice and data services, VIP private line, such as banking, security and aviation. 1.2.7 Gold Services Gold services are applicable to voice and significant data services. Compared with diamond services, gold services have greater bandwidth utilization. 1.2.8 Silver Services Silver services, the revertive time is hundreds of milliseconds to several seconds. The silver level service is suitable for those data or internet services that have low real-time requirement. 1.2.9 Copper Services The copper services are seldom used. Generally, temporary services, such as the abrupt services in holidays, are configured as copper services. 1.2.10 Iron Services The iron services are also seldom used. Generally, temporary services are configured as iron services. For example, when service volume soars, during holidays, the services can be configured as iron services to fully use the bandwidth resources. 1.2.11 OVPN The optical virtual private network (OVPN) divides the TE links in an ASON network to different customers. Sharing the fiber resources, the customers, however, can use and manage only their own TE links and ASON services. 1.2.12 UNI Services

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-5

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

A UNI service is an ASON service that is created automatically after the customer equipment initiates a request to the ASON equipment and the signaling is received. UNI services can be classified into Ethernet UNI services and SDH UNI services.

1.2.1 Basic Concepts of ASON


The basic concepts related to the ASON are the three planes, label switched path (LSP) and rerouting. As shown in Figure 1-1, the ASON has three planes: the control plane, the transport plane, and the management plane. Figure 1-1 Three planes of the ASON

Control plane

Management plane

Transmission plane

ASON
ASON is a new generation optical network that has the following features: l l l l l Customers launch a service request dynamically. Routes are selected automatically. Signaling controls the creation and removal of connections. Network connections are automatically and dynamically completed. Switching and transmission are integrated into one system.

Control Plane
The control plane consists of a group of communication entities. It is responsible for the calling control and connection control, including automatic setting up, releasing, monitoring, and maintaining connections. The control plane automatically restores the failed connections through signaling exchange.

1-6

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Transport Plane
The traditional SDH network is the transport plane. It transmits and multiplexes optical signals, configures cross-connection and protection switching for optical signals, and guarantees the reliability of all optical signals.

Management Plane
The management plane is a complement to the control plane. It maintains the transport plane, the control plane and the whole system. It can configures end to end service. Its functions include performance management, fault management, configuration management and security management.

LSP
Label switched path (LSP) is the path ASON services pass through. In an ASON, to create ASON services is to create LSPs. On U2000, LSP is also called ASON Trail.

Rerouting
Rerouting is a means of resuming services. When an LSP is disconnected, the source node queries and finds the best route to resume services. Then, the initial node creates a new LSP to transmit the service. After creating a new LSP, the source node deletes the original LSP.

CAUTION
After a revertive service reroutes, the original LSP is not deleted.

Rerouting Lockout
In some cases, rerouting is not required after failure of LSP. Then you need to set rerouting lockout.

Rerouting Priority
There are 8 levels of rerouting priority. Level 1 is the highest, and its resource can not be occupied by other levels whenever. The working path of level 2 can not be occupied, but the temp resource used by rerouting can be occupied by level 1 service. Level 3 to level 8 services resources can be occupied by the higher level. When a node or link fails, all the LSPs that are affected by the one-time fault and can be rerouted are restored in the sequence based on the priority levels. That is, the high-priority LSPs are restored first. When the backup network resources are insufficient, the high-priority LSPs can empty the restoring resources of the rerouted low-priority and low-and-delayed-priority LSPs.
NOTE

One-time fault: indicates the collection of faults that occur within the time period (shorter than period T) after a fault occurs. Period T is the "one-time fault delay time".

For the SDH ASON trail, the relationships between priorities and SLA is list in the following table.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-7

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

SLA Diamond Gold Silver Copper Iron

Supported Priority 1,2 1,2 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8 Not Supported

The ASON NE with the version prior than GCP V100R007C03 can not supported eight priority levels, the relationship between old version and new version ASON NE is list in the following table. Priority of ASON NE with GCP V100R007C03 or prior version High Low Low and Delay Priority of ASON NE with GCP V100R007C03 or later version 1 2 3

Rerouting Policy
Diamond, gold and silver services all support the four rerouting polices. l l l l Use existing trails whenever possible: During rerouting, the route of the new LSP overlaps the original route whenever possible. Do not use existing trails whenever possible: During rerouting, the route of the new LSP is separated from the original route whenever possible. No Rerouting constraint: During rerouting, the best route is computed for the new LSP. Use simulated section restoration: There are several TE links between two nodes, but the service only passes one of the links. When a fiber cut occurs in the link that carries the service, the service can first be switched to one of the other available TE links between the two nodes.

1.2.2 Function Structure of the ASON


An ASON network consists of ASON NEs, TE links, domains and SPC (soft permanent connections). See Figure 1-2.

1-8

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-2 Function structure of the ASON

ASON NE

TE Link

UNI interface

R1
SPC

R4

R2

UNI interface

R3
ASON domain :ASON NE :User equipment

ASON NE
An ASON NE is one of the topology components in the ASON. An ASON NE has the following functions in relation to a traditional NE. See Figure 1-3. Figure 1-3 ASON NE
ASON NE Signaling RSVP-TE Routing OSPF-TE

Link management protocolLMP Communication and control Line unit CrossLine unit connection Traditional NE

Node ID is the unique identification of the ASON NE in the control plane. The format of the node ID is the same as that of the IP address. But the node ID and the IP address of the NE must be at different network sections. As a unique identification for NEs on the transport plane, the node ID has the same meaning regarding an ASON NE and a traditional NE. The node ID, the NE ID, and the NE IP address are independent of one another.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-9

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

TE Link
TE link is a traffic engineering link. The ASON NE sends its bandwidth information to other ASON NEs through the TE link to provide data for route computation. One inter-station fiber can be configured with one TE link. The resources of a TE link can be classified into three types: non-protection resources, working resources, and protection resources. If the MSP is configured on some channels of a fiber, there are three types of resources. For example, if a 10 Gbit/s (64 VC4s) optical interface is configured with a 2.5 Gbit/s MSP, the TE links are allocated as follows. l l l 1-8 VC4s are the working resources of the TE link. 33-40 VC4s are the protection resources of the TE link. The rest VC4s are non-protection resources of the TE link.

If the MSP is configured completely in a fiber, there are only working and protection resources in this fiber. If the MSP is not configured in a fiber, there are only non-protection resources in this fiber.

Component Link
Component link is a bandwidth unit smaller than a TE link. One TE link consists of only one component link in the actual ASON software.
NOTE

Each ASON NE floods its own TE links to the whole network through OSPF-TE. Each NE obtains the network-wide TE links. ASON NEs do not flood their own component links to the whole network. They only manage and store their own component links.

ASON Domain
An ASON domain is a subset of a network, which is classified by function for the purpose of route selection and management. An ASON domain consists of several ASON NEs and TE links. One ASON NE belongs to one ASON domain.

SPC
In the case of soft permanent connection (SPC), the connection between the user and the transmission network is configured directly by the NM. The connection within the transmission network, however, is requested by the NM and then created by the NE's control plane through signaling. When ASON service is mentioned, it usually refers to SPC. Permanent connection (PC) is a service connection calculated beforehand and then created through the NM by issuing a command to NE. A traditional SDH service is a PC. Switched connection (SC) is a service connection requested by a terminal user (for example, a router) and is then created in the ASON control plane through signaling.

UNI
The user network interface (UNI) is the standard interface for connecting the transmission network and the client equipment. The client equipment can dynamically request or release the transmission resources by means of control signaling.
1-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

The traditional transmission service configuration is complex and lasts for a long time. The UNI realizes flexible and real-time service transmission in the transmission network, and thus realizes end-to-end configuration of the data service.
NOTE

The UNI service connection is performed in the SC mode.

1.2.3 ASON Protocol


Huawei OptiX GCP applies the link management protocol (LMP) as the link management protocol, OSPF-TE as the routing protocol, and RSVP-TE as the signaling protocol. The following sections describe the functions of these protocols in an ASON network.

LMP
The LMP performs the following functions in an ASON network. l Creating and maintaining the control channels between adjacent nodes. The following is the procedure of creating control channels. See Figure 1-4. When two adjacent ASON NEs start up, the LMP uses the Ethernet or the D4-D12 bytes of DCC to transmit messages. Node 1 transmits messages to Node 2, which performs the check to the received messages. If the messages pass the check, Node 2 returns messages to Node 1. If the messages do not pass the check, Node 2 returns a message to Node 1, indicating that the messages fail to pass the check. In this way, Node 2 waits for another check. Hence, a control channel between the two adjacent nodes is created. After the control channel is created, the two nodes store the information about the control channel and identify the control channel according to the ID. Figure 1-4 Creating control channels
LMP LMP

Message Node 1 Message Node 2

Verifying component links and TE links. The following is the procedure of verifying component links and TE Links. After a logical board is created for an ASON NE, the ASON software creates component links for the optical interfaces of the board. Then, the attributes of component links are configured according to the attributes of the optical interface. The attributes include slot number, optical interface number, bandwidth and node ID. After component links are created, the ASON software creates corresponding TE links. In this case, the LMP starts to verify the component links and TE links. The LMP

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-11

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

performs the verification to verify the consistency of information at both ends of a link. As shown in Figure 1-5, Node 1 transmits messages and the content to be checked to Node 2, which checks if it has the same information and returns the check result to Node 1. If the verification shows consistency, the OSPF-TE can then flood the information about the TE links to the entire network. Figure 1-5 Verifying component links and TE links
LMP Message LMP

Node 1

Node 2

Message

OSPF-TE
The control plane of Huawei OptiX GCP applies the OSPF-TE, which is an extended protocol for OSPF, and performs the following functions. l l l Creates neighbor relations. Creates and maintains control links. Floods and collects the information about the control links on the control plane. According to the information, the protocol then generates the information about the routes that are required for forwarding messages on the control plane. Floods and collects the information about the TE links on the transport plane. The protocol then generates the information about the network service topologies for service trail computation.

RSVP-TE
The RSVP-TE is a protocol for resource reservation. It is a type of signaling. In terms of traffic engineering, the RSVP is extended to RSVP-TE. The RSVP-TE mainly supports the following functions: l l l l l LSP creation LSP deletion LSP attribute modification LSP rerouting LSP trail optimization

Protocol Encryption
An external entity may modify the OSPF-TE protocol packets of the network, counterfeit a node of this network and transmit packets, or receive the packets transmitted by nodes in the network and repeat the attack. To prevent these network insecurities, the ASON provides the function to
1-12 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

encrypt protocols. In an ASON domain, the RSVP and OSPF-TE protocols are encrypted for authentication. The RSVP authentication is configured for nodes and the OSPF-TE authentication for interconnected interfaces (slots and optical interfaces). The authentication can be non-authentication, plain text authentication or MD5 authentication. l l l Non-authentication: No authentication is required in this mode. Plain text authentication: To verify the preset password. The authentication code must be a character string with no more than eight characters. MD5 authentication: To verify the information that is encrypted by the MD5 algorithm. The authentication code must be a character string with no more than 64 characters.

The check succeeds only when the authentication modes and passwords of adjacent nodes are the same.

UNI Protocol
The UNI is the standard interface for connecting the transmission network and the client equipment. Currently, there are two schemes, namely, OIF and GMPLS. The equipment supports the following UNI interface functions: l l l l l Establishes the SDH UNI service. Establish the Ethernet UNI service. Deletes the SDH UNI service. Deletes the Ethernet UNI service. UNI Access Policy and Security Policy Management

1.2.4 ASON Links


ASON Links include control channels, control links, component links and TE links.

Control Channels
The LMP creates and maintains the control channel between NEs. The control channel then provides a physical channel for the LMP packets. The control channels are classified into infiber and out-fiber control channels. The in-fiber control channels automatically find and use the D4-D12 bytes of DCC. The out-fiber control channel uses the Ethernet links, which should be manually configured. The verification of component links and TE links can be performed if the control channels are available between two adjacent nodes. At least one control channel should be present between two adjacent nodes. If several fibers exist between adjacent nodes, several control channels can be created. The LMP selects only one control channel to transmit protocol packets at a time.

Control Links
Control links are the communication links created for the communication between the protocol entities of NEs. The OSPF control links are created and maintained by the OSPF protocol between two nodes. The information of the OSPF control links are flooded to the entire network. In this way, each
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-13

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

NE can attain the information and then can form the control topology. The OSPF protocol of each NE computes the shortest control routes to each NE according to the control topology. The routes are then recorded in the forward table. The signaling RSVP then uses the routes to transmit message packets. By default, control links are created in fibers. Control links can also be created outside fibers on the condition that the OSPF protocol of the Ethernet ports is enabled.
NOTE

Although the control links and control channels are created in the DCC channels (D4-D12), they differ in terms of functions and are independent of each other. The OSPF-TE protocol floods the information about the control links to the entire network. Each ASON NE stores the information about the network-wide control links. The ASON NEs do not flood the information about the control channels to the entire network. Each NE only manages and stores the information about its own control channels.

TE Links
TE link is a traffic engineering link. The ASON NE sends its bandwidth information to other ASON NEs through the TE link to provide data for route computation. As a kind of resources, TE links can be regarded as fibers that have bandwidth information and protection attributes. However, the TE link does not correspond to a fiber respectively, because each fiber may correspond to many TE links. Currently, a fiber can be configured with one TE link. The resources of a TE link can be classified into three types: non-protection resources, working resources, and protection resources. l If the MSP is configured on some channels of a fiber, there are three types of resources. For example, if a 10 Gbit/s (64 VC4s) optical interface is configured with a 2.5 Gbit/s MSP, the TE links are allocated as follows. 1-8 VC4s are the working resources of the TE link. 33-40 VC4s are the protection resources of the TE link. The rest VC4s are non-protection resources of the TE link. l l If the MSP is configured completely in a fiber, there are only working and protection resources in this fiber. If the MSP is not configured in a fiber, there are only non-protection resources in this fiber.

Component Links
Component link is a bandwidth unit smaller than a TE link. One TE link consists of only one component link in the actual ASON software.
NOTE

Each ASON NE floods its own TE links to the whole network through OSPF-TE. Each NE obtains the network-wide TE links. ASON NEs do not flood their own component links to the whole network. They only manage and store their own component links.

UNI Links
The UNI link is the TE link between the client equipment and a network node. The client equipment can establish the UNI service through the UNI link.

1.2.5 SLA
The ASON network can provide services of different QoS to different clients.
1-14 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

The service level agreement (SLA) is used to classify services according to the service protection, as listed in Table 1-1. The rerouting time is related to the device type, interrupted service, network resource and setting. The data are listed as follows only for reference. Table 1-1 Service level Service Protection and Restoration Scheme Protection and restoration Implementation Means SNCP and rerouting Switching and Rerouting Time Switching time < 50ms Rerouting time < 2 s Gold service Protection and restoration MSP and rerouting Switching time < 50ms Rerouting time < 2 s Silver service Copper service Restoration No protection No restoration Iron service Preemptable MSP Rerouting Rerouting time < 2 s -

Diamond service

Table 1-2 lists details of the TE links used by ASON services. Table 1-2 TE links used by ASON services Service Level Working Resource of TE Link Service creation Service rerouting Service optimization rowsep="1" Gold service Service creation Not used Not used Protection Resource of TE Link Not used Used when the resource is not enough Not used Not used NonProtection Resource of TE Link Used Used with the priority Used Used when the resource is not enough Used when the resource is not enough

rowsep="1" Diamond service

Not used Used with the priority Used with the priority

Service rerouting

Used when the resource is not enough

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-15

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Service Level

Working Resource of TE Link Service optimization Used with the priority Not used Not used

Protection Resource of TE Link Not used

NonProtection Resource of TE Link Used when the resource is not enough Used Used with the priority Used Used Used Used when the resource is not enough Used when the resource is not enough

Silver service

Service creation Service rerouting Service optimization

Not used Used when the resource is not enough Not used Not used Not used Used with the priority Used with the priority

Not used Not used Not used Not used

Copper service

Service creation Service optimization

Iron service

Service creation

Service optimization

Not used

1.2.6 Diamond Services


Diamond services have the best protection ability. When there are enough resources in the network, diamond services provide a permanent 1+1 protection. Diamond services are applicable to voice and data services, VIP private line, such as banking, security and aviation. A diamond service is a service with 1+1 protection from the source node to the sink node. It is also called a 1+1 service. For a diamond service, there are two different LSPs available between the source node and the sink node. The two LSPs should be as separate as possible. One is the working LSP and the other is the protection LSP. The same service is transmitted to the working LSP and the protection LSP at the same time. If the working LSP is normal, the sink node receives the service from the working LSP; otherwise, from the protection LSP. Figure 1-6 shows a diamond service.

1-16

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-6 Diamond Services


Working LSP

R1
D

R4
I F

A B

C H

R2

R3
Protection LSP :ASON NE :User equipment

There are three types of diamond services. l l l Permanent 1+1 diamond service: rerouting is triggered once an LSP fails. Rerouting 1+1 diamond service: rerouting is triggered only when both LSPs fail. Non-rerouting diamond service: rerouting is never triggered.

Table 1-3 lists the attributes of the permanent 1+1 diamond service. Table 1-4 lists the attributes of the rerouting 1+1 diamond service. Table 1-5 lists the attributes of the non-rerouting 1+1 diamond service. Table 1-3 Attributes of the permanent 1+1 diamond services Attribute Requirements for creation Protection and restoration Permanent 1+1 Diamond Service Sufficient non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node. l If the resources are sufficient, two LSPs are always available for a permanent 1+1 diamond service. One is the active LSP and the other is the standby LSP. l If the resources are not sufficient, one LSP can still be reserved for a permanent 1+1 diamond service to ensure the service survivability.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-17

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Rerouting

Permanent 1+1 Diamond Service l Supports rerouting lockout. l Supports rerouting priority. l Supports four rerouting policies: Use existing trails whenever possible Do not use existing trails whenever possible No rerouting constraint Use simulated section restoration l Supports setting the revertive mode. l Supports setting the trigger condition. l Supports setting the WTR time. l Supports setting the crankback times. l Supports rerouting triggered by B3 bit error. l Supports setting the rerouting hold-off time. l Supports setting the revertive lockout.

Revertive

Supports Automatically Revertive, Non-Revertive, and Scheduled revertive. l After the automatically revertive diamond service is rerouted, the service is automatically reverted to the original path if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the scheduled revertive diamond service is rerouted, the user can set the service to be reverted to the original path at a specific future time (ranging from 10 minutes to 30 days) on the NMS if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the non-revertive diamond service is rerouted, the service is not reverted to the original route after the fault is rectified.

Preset restoring trail Service migration

Supports setting the preset restoring trail. l Supports migration between diamond services and permanent SNCP connections. l Supports migration between diamond services and gold services. l Supports migration between diamond services and silver services. l Supports migration between diamond services and copper services.

Service switching Service optimization Service association ASON server trail

Supports manual switching. Supports service optimization. Does not support service association. Support diamond ASON server trails.

1-18

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Alarms to trigger rerouting

Permanent 1+1 Diamond Service R_LOS, R_LOF, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI, AU_AIS, B3_EXC (can be set), B3_SD (can be set)

Table 1-4 Attributes of the rerouting 1+1 diamond service Attribute Requirements for creation Protection and restoration Rerouting 1+1 Diamond Service Sufficient non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node l When the standby LSP fails, services are not switched. Rerouting is not triggered. l When the active LSP fails, services are switched to the standby LSP for transmission. Rerouting is not triggered. l When both the active and the standby LSPs fail, rerouting is triggered to create a new LSP to restore services. Rerouting l Supports rerouting lockout. l Supports rerouting priority. l Supports four rerouting policies: Use existing trails whenever possible Do not use existing trails whenever possible No rerouting constraint Use simulated section restoration l Supports setting the revertive mode. l Supports setting the trigger condition. l Supports setting the WTR time. l Supports setting the crankback times. l Supports rerouting triggered by B3 bit error. l Supports setting the rerouting hold-off time. l Supports setting the revertive lockout. Revertive Supports Automatically Revertive, Non-Revertive, and Scheduled revertive. l After the automatically revertive diamond service is rerouted, the service is automatically reverted to the original path if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the scheduled revertive diamond service is rerouted, the user can set the service to be reverted to the original path at a specific future time (ranging from 10 minutes to 30 days) on the NMS if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the non-revertive diamond service is rerouted, the service is not reverted to the original route after the fault is rectified.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-19

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Preset restoring trail Service migration

Rerouting 1+1 Diamond Service Supports setting the preset restoring trail. l Supports migration between diamond services and permanent SNCP connections. l Supports migration between diamond services and gold services. l Supports migration between diamond services and silver services. l Supports migration between diamond services and copper services.

Service switching Service optimization Service association ASON server trail Alarms to trigger rerouting

Supports manual switching. Supports service optimization. Does not support service association. Support diamond ASON server trails. R_LOS, R_LOF, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI, AU_AIS, B3_EXC (can be set), B3_SD (can be set)

Table 1-5 Attributes of the non-rerouting 1+1 diamond service Attribute Requirements for creation Protection and restoration Non-rerouting 1+1 diamond service Sufficient non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node l When the active LSP fails, services are switched to the standby LSP for transmission. Rerouting is not triggered. l When the standby LSP fails, services are not switched. Rerouting is not triggered. l When both the active and the standby LSPs fail, rerouting is not triggered. Service migration l Supports migration between diamond services and permanent SNCP connections. l Supports migration between diamond services and gold services. l Supports migration between diamond services and silver services. l Supports migration between diamond services and copper services. Service switching Service optimization Service association
1-20

Supports manual switching. Supports service optimization. Does not support service association.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute ASON server trail

Non-rerouting 1+1 diamond service Support diamond ASON server trails.

1.2.7 Gold Services


Gold services are applicable to voice and significant data services. Compared with diamond services, gold services have greater bandwidth utilization. A gold service needs only one LSP. This LSP must use working resource of TE links or nonprotection resource of TE links. When a fiber on the path of a gold service is cut, the ASON triggers MSP switching to protect the service at first. If the multiplex section protection fails, the ASON triggers rerouting to restore the service. As shown in Figure 1-7, a gold service can be configured from A to I. Figure 1-7 Gold services

R1
D A

R4
E F C

MSP
I

MSP
B

MSP
G

R2

R3
:ASON NE :User equipment

Table 1-6 lists the attributes of gold services. Table 1-6 Attributes of gold services Attribute Requirements for creation Gold Service Sufficient working resources or non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-21

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Multiplex section protection

Gold Service l Supports using the working resources of a 1:1 linear multiplex section protection chain to create gold services. l Supports using the working resources of a 1+1 linear multiplex section protection chain to create gold services. l Supports using the working resources of a 1:N linear multiplex section protection chain to create gold services. l Supports using the working resources of a two-fiber bidirectional multiplex section protection ring to create gold services. l Supports using the working resources of a four-fiber bidirectional multiplex section protection ring to create gold services.

Protection and restoration

When a fiber is cut for the first time, MS switching is performed to protect services. When MS switching fails, rerouting is then triggered to restore services. l Supports rerouting lockout. l Supports rerouting priority. l Supports four rerouting policies: Use existing trails whenever possible Do not use existing trails whenever possible No rerouting constraint Use simulated section restoration l Supports setting the revertive mode. l Supports setting the WTR time. l Supports setting the crankback times. l Supports rerouting triggered by B3 bit error. l Supports setting the rerouting hold-off time. l Supports setting the revertive lockout.

Rerouting

Revertive

Supports Automatically Revertive, Non-Revertive, and Scheduled revertive. l After the automatically revertive gold service is rerouted, the service is automatically reverted to the original path if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the scheduled revertive gold service is rerouted, the user can set the service to be reverted to the original path at a specific future time (ranging from 10 minutes to 30 days) on the NMS if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the non-revertive gold service is rerouted, the service is not reverted to the original route after the fault is rectified.

Preset restoring trail

Supports setting the preset restoring trail.

1-22

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Service migration

Gold Service l Supports migration between permanent connections and gold services. l Supports migration between gold services and diamond services. l Supports migration between gold services and silver services. l Supports migration between gold services and copper services.

Service switching Service optimization ASON server trail Alarms to trigger rerouting

Supports manual switching. Supports service optimization. Supports gold ASON server trails. R_LOS, R_LOF, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI, AU_AIS, B3_EXC (can be set), B3_SD (can be set)

1.2.8 Silver Services


Silver services, the revertive time is hundreds of milliseconds to several seconds. The silver level service is suitable for those data or internet services that have low real-time requirement. Silver services are also called rerouting services. When an LSP failure, the ASON triggers rerouting to restore the service. If there are not enough resources, service may be interrupted. As shown in Figure 1-8, A-B-G-H-I is a silver service trail. If the fiber between B and G is cut, the ASON triggers rerouting from A to create a new LSP that does not pass the cut fiber. Hence, services are protected. Figure 1-8 A silver service

R1
D A B C

E LSP after rerouting I F

R4

R2
Original LSP

R3
: ASON NE : User equipment

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-23

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-7 lists the attributes of silver services. Table 1-7 Attributes of silver services Attribute Requirements for creation Service restoration Rerouting Silver Services Sufficient non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node. When the original LSP fails, rerouting is triggered to create a new LSP to restore services. l Supports rerouting lockout. l Supports rerouting priority. l Supports four rerouting policies: Use existing trails whenever possible Do not use existing trails whenever possible No rerouting constraint Use simulated section restoration l Supports setting the revertive mode. l Supports setting the WTR time. l Supports setting the crankback times. l Supports rerouting triggered by B3 bit error. l Supports setting the rerouting hold-off time. l Supports setting the revertive lockout status. Revertive Supports Automatically Revertive, Non-Revertive, and Scheduled revertive. l After the automatically revertive silver service is rerouted, the service is automatically reverted to the original path if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the scheduled revertive silver service is rerouted, the user can set the service to be reverted to the original path at a specific future time (ranging from 10 minutes to 30 days) on the NMS if the fault in the original path is rectified. l After the non-revertive silver service is rerouted, the service is not reverted to the original route after the fault is rectified. Preset restoring trail Shared mesh restoration trail Supports setting the preset restoring trail. Supports setting the shared mesh restoration trial for revertive silver trials.

1-24

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Service migration

Silver Services l Supports migration between permanent connections and silver services. l Supports migration between diamond services and silver services. l Supports migration between gold services and silver services. l Supports migration between silver services and copper services.

Service optimization

l Supports service optimization. l If a revertive silver service reroutes, it cannot be optimized before reverting to its original route.

Service association ASON server trail Alarms to trigger rerouting

Supports service association. Supports silver ASON server trails. R_LOS, R_LOF, B2_EXC, B2_SD, MS_AIS, MS_RDI, AU_AIS, B3_EXC (can be set), B3_SD (can be set)

1.2.9 Copper Services


The copper services are seldom used. Generally, temporary services, such as the abrupt services in holidays, are configured as copper services. Copper services are also called non-protection services. If an LSP fails, services do not reroute and are interrupted. Table 1-8 lists the attributes of copper services. Table 1-8 Attributes of copper services Attribute Requirements for creation Service restoration Service migration Silver Service Sufficient non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node. Does not support rerouting. l Supports migration between copper services and traditional services. l Supports migration between copper services and diamond services. l Supports migration between copper services and gold services. l Supports migration between copper services and silver services. Service optimization Service association Supports service optimization. Supports service association.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-25

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute ASON server trail

Silver Service Supports ASON server trails.

1.2.10 Iron Services


The iron services are also seldom used. Generally, temporary services are configured as iron services. For example, when service volume soars, during holidays, the services can be configured as iron services to fully use the bandwidth resources. An iron service is also called a preemptable service. Iron services apply non-protection resources or protection resources of the TE link to create LSPs. When an LSP fails, services are interrupted and rerouting is not triggered. l When the iron service uses the protection resources of the TE link, if the MS switching occurs, the iron service is preempted and the service is interrupted. After the MS is recovered, the iron service is restored. The interruption, preemption and restoration of the iron service are all reported to the U2000. When the iron service uses the non-protection resources, if the network resources are insufficient, the iron service may be preempted by the rerouted silver service or diamond service. Thus, the service is interrupted.

Table 1-9 lists the attributes of iron service. Table 1-9 Attributes of iron services Attribute Requirements for creation Multiplex section protection Iron Service Sufficient protection resources or non-protection resources are available between the source node and the sink node. To create iron services, the following resources can be used: l Protection resources of 1:1 linear MSP l Protection resources of 1:N linear MSP l Protection resources of two-fiber bidirectional MSP l Protection resources of four-fiber bidirectional MSP Service restoration Service migration Service optimization Does not support rerouting. Supports migration between iron services and extra permanent connections. Supports service optimization.

1-26

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.2.11 OVPN
The optical virtual private network (OVPN) divides the TE links in an ASON network to different customers. Sharing the fiber resources, the customers, however, can use and manage only their own TE links and ASON services. As shown in Figure 1-9, certain timeslot resources are separately allocated to OVPN customers 1 and 2. The network management (NM) users of OVPN customers 1 and 2 are separately created on the U2000. Then, OVPN customers 1 and 2 can log in to the U2000 through their respective clients and NM users. OVPN customers 1 and 2 can separately manage and maintain their timeslot resources and ASON services. Multiple NM users can be created for one OVPN customer. One NM user can manage multiple OVPN customers. Figure 1-9 Networking diagram of an OVPN

Server

Client

Client

Client

OVPN Customer 1

NM User Admin

OVPN Customer 2 Timeslot resouce of OVPN customer 1 Timeslot resouce of OVPN customer 2

Enabling the OVPN Function


To perform the OVPN function, you must ensure that all the ASON NEs in the ASON domain enable the OVPN function. In addition, the OVPN License can be started on the NMS side.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-27

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Only administrator user of the U2000 can enable or disable the OVPN of an NE.

OVPN Customer
After you can create a customer with an OVPN ID, in the subsequent resource allocation, you can allocate the timeslots of links to the customer, binding the resources with the customer. This customer is also named OVPN customer. The links that are allocated to the OVPN customer is considered as constraints when you create a service. In this way, the service passes only the links that are allocated to the OVPN customer. Currently, a maximum of 60,000 OVPN customers can be created on the U2000.

Allocating the OVPN


The allocation of OVPN resources refers to allocating the TE links to different OVPN customers. After being allocated, the TE links are classified as the follows: shared resources and OVPN customer resources. See Figure 1-10. Figure 1-10 Allocating TE links
VC4 timeslot .

TE

. . . . . . . . .
VC4 timeslot

Shared Resource

OVPN Customer Resource

NOTE

To allocate the TE links on the MSP ring for OVPN customers, ensure that the timeslots are consistent with each other in each segment.

OVPN NM User
On an OVPN network, an OVPN user manages OVPN customer resources and services. After allocating links to OVPN customers, the pipe provider needs to create NM users the OVPN customers and allocate the corresponding rights to the NM users. Each NM user represents the corresponding OVPN customer. An OVPN customer logs into the NM and manages its own OVPN network by using the corresponding NM user name and password. Considering the security of an OVPN network, you need to allocate appropriate rights to OVPN NM users as required.
1-28 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

OVPN Services
Table 1-10 lists the OVPN service attributes. Table 1-10 OVPN service attributes Attribute Creating a service OVPN Service l When creating a service, the NM user admin can use the shared resources and OVPN user resources. Each OVPN service can use only the timeslot resources of the same color. l An OVPN customer can create a service on the resources only allocated to the OVPN customer. Rerouting When the OVPN service is rerouted, it can use the resources allocated to the OVPN customer first. If the OVPN customer resources are not available, the OVPN service can use the shared resources. A restoration trail can be preset. An OVPN customer can use the allocated resources only. A shared Mesh restoration trail can be preset. An OVPN customer can use the allocated resources only. OVPN services and traditional services can be mutually switched from each other. l To switch an SDH service to an ASON service, you need to switch the static SDH resources to the ASON resources. l After an ASON service is degraded to an SDH service, the original ASON service switch to the static SDH resources. Service optimization An ASON service of an OVPN user can be optimized on the resources only allocated to the OVPN customer.

Presetting the restoration trail Shared Mesh restoration trail Service switching

1.2.12 UNI Services


A UNI service is an ASON service that is created automatically after the customer equipment initiates a request to the ASON equipment and the signaling is received. UNI services can be classified into Ethernet UNI services and SDH UNI services.

Ethernet UNI Services


Ethernet UNI services are created in the ASON network after the customer equipment initiates a service request to the ASON network by transmitting GMPLS signalling. Ethernet UNI services are used to transmit GE signals, as shown in Figure 1-11. The service requests are classified into OIF UNI service requests and GMPLS UNI service requests. In the case of OIF UNI service requests, the message contains the information such as source TNA address, sink TNA address, logical port number, service rate, and service level. In the ASON network, a node first translates the source and sink TNA addresses into the source and sink node IDs. Then, the node computes multiple service paths according to the service rate. Finally, the node creates the relevant server-layer path according to the service level.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-29

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

In the case of GMPLS UNI service requests, the message contains the information such as source IP address, sink IP address, service rate, service priority, and access policy. In the ASON network, a node first translates the source and sink IP addresses into the node IDs of the two access nodes in the transport network. Then, the node computes multiple server-layer paths according to the service rate. Finally, the node creates the relevant server-layer path according to the service level. Ethernet UNI services are available at four types: diamond, gold, silver, and copper. Figure 1-11 Ethernet UNI services
Ethernet UNI service

R1 ASON

R2

GE Interface

GE Interface

: ASON NE : Customer equipment

GE

Ethernet board

SDH UNI Services


SDH UNI services are created in the ASON network after the customer equipment initiates a service request to the ASON network by transmitting GMPLS signalling. SDH UNI services are used to transmit POS signals (including SDH concatenation signals), as shown in Figure 1-12. The service requests are classified into OIF UNI service requests and GMPLS UNI service requests. In the case of OIF UNI service requests, the message contains the information such as source TNA address, sink TNA address, logical port number, service rate, and service level. In the ASON network, a node first translates the source and sink TNA addresses into the source and sink node IDs. Then, the node computes multiple server-layer (concatenation) service paths according to the service rate. Finally, the node creates the relevant server-layer service according to the service level. In the case of GMPLS UNI service requests, the message contains the information such as source IP address, sink IP address, service rate, service priority, and access policy. In the ASON network, a node first translates the source and sink IP addresses into the node IDs of the two access nodes in the transport network. Then, the node computes multiple server-layer
1-30 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

(concatenation) service paths according to the service rate. Finally, the node creates the relevant server-layer service according to the service level. SDH UNI services are available at four types: diamond, gold, silver, and copper. Figure 1-12 SDH UNI services
SDH UNI Service

R1 ASON

R2

SDH Interface

SDH Interface

: ASON NE : Customer equipment

Optical interface board

1.3 Creating an ASON Topology


The ASON network uses the route protocol to create the topology information of the nodes in the network so that each node can obtain a networkwide topology. The U2000 can discover other ASON NEs in the network from any ASON NE.

Context
NOTE

l An ASON NE can only belong to one ASON domain. l The configuration data of each newly created ASON NE must be uploaded from the NE side. l Because of some DCN communication problems, the topology and TE link information on the U2000 may be inconsistent with the data on the NE. In this case, perform NE data synchronization to maintain data consistency.

1.3.1 Creating NEs in Batches When the U2000 communicates properly with a GNE, you can search for all NEs that communicate with the GNE by using the IP address of the GNE or the network segment to which the IP address is associated, or by using the NSAP address of the NE. Then, you can create NEs in batches. This method is quicker and more accurate than manual creation. 1.3.2 Creating a Single NE
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-31

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

The U2000 to manage the NE. Although creating a single NE is not as fast and exact as creating NEs in batches, you can use this method regardless of whether the data is configured on the NE or not. 1.3.3 Setting the Node ID The node ID, NE ID and IP address of the NE are independent from each other. In an ASON network, each ASON NE is assigned with a unique node ID within a network. The node ID must be specified during the network planning. 1.3.4 Enabling the ASON Feature The NE obtains the ASON feature after this feature is enabled. The ASON feature is disabled by default during delivery. 1.3.5 Uploading NE Configuration Data After the ASON software of an NE is enabled, the ASON NE automatically generates data on the NE. Considering that the data dynamically changes as the system runs, you can upload data to the U2000 to ensure that the data on the U2000 is consistent with that on the NE. Do not use the U2000 to initialize the ASON NE or download data to the ASON NE. 1.3.6 Enable the ASON Feature of a Board In the case of an ASON NE, the ASON feature of the optical interface board of the STM-1 or STM-4 level is disabled by default. The boards of the two levels cannot be used to create an ASON service. To create an ASON service by using the boards of the two levels, you need to enable the ASON features of the boards. The ASON feature of the optical interface board of the STM-16 or STM-64 level, however, is enabled by default. You can also disable the ASON features of the boards of the two levels as required. 1.3.7 Creating Domains for an ASON Network The U2000 manages an ASON network based on ASON domains. Usually, ASON domains are automatically created. If for some reason, there are NEs that fail to be synchronized to the ASON domain during the NE upload, you can create an ASON domain and assign the ASON NEs that belong to the same ASON network to the ASON domain. 1.3.8 Synchronizing ASON NEs By communicating with the primary NE, the U2000 is kept synchronous with an ASON network and automatically discovers other ASON NEs in the network. 1.3.9 Automatically Creating Fibers According to TE Link An ASON network can automatically discover TE links. The U2000 can create fibers between NEs according to the TE links. 1.3.10 Setting the Primary NE or Secondary NE In an ASON network, each ASON NE is capable of obtaining the networkwide topology information. The primary NE is the ASON NE that represents the ASON to communicate with the U2000. It obtains the information of the ASON control plane and reports ASON events to the U2000. To improve the reliability, another NE can be set as the standby of the primary NE. If the primary NE fails, the secondary NE takes over to communicate with the U2000. Usually, you can select the GNE as the primary NE or as the secondary NE to avoid waste of the ECC bandwidth. 1.3.11 Setting Control Plane Parameters You can set the control plane parameters of an ASON NE. The parameters contain the bandwidth load, bandwidth weight, distance weight, and hop weight. 1.3.12 Viewing ASON NE Software Version

1-32

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Different ASON software versions provide different functions. By viewing the version of the ASON software running on an NE, you can know the ASON feature of the NE. This help you to configure, manage, maintain and troubleshoot the ASON NE.

1.3.1 Creating NEs in Batches


When the U2000 communicates properly with a GNE, you can search for all NEs that communicate with the GNE by using the IP address of the GNE or the network segment to which the IP address is associated, or by using the NSAP address of the NE. Then, you can create NEs in batches. This method is quicker and more accurate than manual creation.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE administrator" authority or higher. The U2000 must communicate properly with the GNE. The NE Explorer instance of the NEs must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Discovery > NE from the main menu. Step 2 Click the Transport NE Search tab. Step 3 Optional: Enter the network segment or IP addresses NEs to search for the NEs. 1. 2. Click Add and the Input Search Domain dialog box is displayed. Set Address type to IP Address Range of GNE, IP Address of GNE, or NSAP Address, and enter Search Address, User Name, and Password. Then, click OK.

NOTE

You can repeat Steps a through b to add more search domains. You can delete the system default search domain. l If you use IP address to search for NEs: l Usually, the broadcast function is disabled on the routers on a network, to avoid network broadcast storm. Therefore, by using the IP Address Range of GNE method, only the NEs in the same network segment can be searched out. l To search the network segments across routers, the IP Address of GNE method is recommended. Through a gateway NE, you can search out the NEs in the network segment of the gateway NE.

Step 4 Optional: If you fail to enter a network segment correctly, enable IP auto discovery and enter the User Name and Password of the NEs.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-33

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

After enabling IP auto discovery, you can obtain the IP address of the GNE and search out all the NEs related to the GNE. If the U2000 and an gateway NE are connected through a router, you need to create an NE by using the IP address of the gateway NE.

Step 5 In the Search for NE area, perform the following operations: l Select Create device after search, enter the NE User and Password.

NOTE

l The default NE user is root. l The default password is password.

Select Upload after create. The data related to the NEs are uploaded to the U2000 after the NEs are created.
NOTE

You can select all options in the Search for NE area to search for NEs, create NEs, and upload the NE data at a time.

Step 6 Click Next and the Result area is displayed. Step 7 Optional: If you select Search for NE only, you can select the NEs, which are not yet created, in the Result list after the search for NEs is complete. Click Create and then the Create dialog box is displayed. Enter User Name and Password in the Create dialog box, and then click OK. Step 8 Optional: Click Change NE ID. Then, the Change NE ID dialog box is displayed. Users can check against the Bar Code List by the value of Bar Code, and then modify the NE Name, Extend NE ID, Base NE ID, and IP Address fields accordingly.

NOTE

The Bar Code List is provided by the hardware installation personnel to the software commissioning personnel. The list contains the bar codes of stations.

----End
1-34 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Postrequisite
After an NE is created, if you fail to log in to the NE, possible causes are listed as follows: l l The password for the NE user is incorrect. Enter the correct password for the NE user. The NE user is invalid or the NE user is already logged in. Change to use a valid NE user.

1.3.2 Creating a Single NE


The U2000 to manage the NE. Although creating a single NE is not as fast and exact as creating NEs in batches, you can use this method regardless of whether the data is configured on the NE or not.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The license must be installed and the license must support creating the NE of the type. The NE Explorer instance of the NEs must be created.

Background Information
First create a GNE, and then create a non-gateway NE. If the NE is not created properly or the communication between the NE and the U2000 is abnormal, the NE is displayed in gray color.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose File > Create > NE from the main menu. The Create NE dialog box is displayed. Step 2 Select the NE type from the Object Type tree. Step 3 Complete the following information: ID, Extended ID, Name and Remarks. Step 4 To create a GNE, proceed to Step 5. To create a non-gateway NE, proceed to Step 6. Step 5 Choose Gateway Type, Protocol and set the IP address and NSAP address. 1. 2. Select Gateway from the Gateway Type drop-down list. Select the Protocol type. If the U2000 communicates with NEs through IP protocol Do...

Select IP from the Protocol drop-down list. Enter the IP Address and use the default value for the Port number of the GNE. Select OSI from the Protocol drop-down list. Enter the NSAP Address of the GNE.

OSI protocol

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-35

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

The NSAP address is a hexadecimal number that contains a maximum of 20 bytes. Its format is: domain address+08003e+NE ID+NSEL. The domain address that contains a maximum of 13 bytes is entered by the user. NSEL is the port number of the network-level protocol, with a fixed value of 1d (one byte).

Step 6 Select Non-Gateway from the Gateway Type drop-down list. Select the GNE to which the NE is associated to from the Affiliated Gateway drop-down list. Step 7 Enter the NE User and Password.
NOTE

The default NE user is root, and the default password is password.

Step 8 Optional: If you do not want to apply the NE configuration data in the U2000 to the NE, check the NE Preconfiguration check box, and set NE Software Version.
NOTE

If you apply the configuration data of the preconfigured NE to the actual NE when the configuration data on the preconfigured NE is inconsistent with that on the actual NE, the actual services will be affected.

Step 9 Click OK. Then, click in the blank space of the Main Topology and the NE icon appears in the position where you clicked. ----End

Result
After an NE is successfully created, the system automatically saves the information, such as the IP address, NSAP address, subnet mask, and NE ID to the U2000 database.

Postrequisite
After an NE is created, if you fail to log in to the NE, possible causes are listed as follows: l l l The communication between the U2000 and the NE is abnormal. Check the settings of communication parameters, such as the IP address of the NE and NE ID. The password for the NE user is incorrect. Enter the correct password for the NE user. The NE user is invalid or the NE user is already logged in. Change to use a valid NE user.

1.3.3 Setting the Node ID


The node ID, NE ID and IP address of the NE are independent from each other. In an ASON network, each ASON NE is assigned with a unique node ID within a network. The node ID must be specified during the network planning.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher. No ASON services exist on the NE.

Background Information
The node ID must meet the following requirements: l
1-36

Node IDs cannot be duplicate in the same ASON domain.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l l l l

The node ID of an NE cannot be in the same network segment as the IP address of the NE. The node ID, NE ID and IP address of the NE are independent from each other. The format of a node ID is the same as that of an IP address. The node ID cannot be 0.0.0.0, 1.2.3.4 or 255.255.255.255. Node IDs must be set before the ASON feature is enabled. After the node ID is set, a warm reset is performed on the NE.

CAUTION
When a delivered network is running, do not change the node ID. To change the node ID, contact Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Node ID Management tab. Step 2 Click Query to view the current node ID of the NE. Step 3 Double-click the Node ID field to enter a node ID for the NE.

Step 4 Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt is displayed indicating that the operation was successful.
NOTE

You can also set the NE node ID in ASON Topology Management.

----End

1.3.4 Enabling the ASON Feature


The NE obtains the ASON feature after this feature is enabled. The ASON feature is disabled by default during delivery.

Prerequisite
l l l l You must be an NM user with "NE administrator" authority or higher. The NE software must contain the ASON feature and must be successfully enabled. The NE must be in the running state. The NE must be created on the U2000 and the NE data must be already uploaded.

Background Information
l A unique node ID is allocated to each ASON NE to identify the NE in the ASON network. In the same ASON network, node IDs cannot be duplicate or in the same network segment as the IP address of the corresponding NE. The format of a node ID is the same as that of an IP address. The node ID cannot be 0.0.0.0, 1.2.3.4 or 255.255.255.255. Properly set the NE node ID before you enable the ASON feature of the NE.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-37

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l l l l

The ASON feature can be enabled after the equipment commissioning is complete. Add the correct logical boards on the NE before enabling the ASON features. Set the correct DCC working mode for the NE before enabling the ASON features. After you enable the ASON feature, upload the NE data to keep the consistency of data between the U2000 and the NE. For relevant operations, refer to 1.3.5 Uploading NE Configuration Data. You can disable the ASON feature of an ASON NE according to the project requirement. After you disable the ASON feature, the NE is possessed of only traditional NE features.
NOTE

To disable the ASON feature, the NE must meet the following requirements: l The NE must be in the running state and does not have any ASON cross-connection or ASON service residual l The fiber between the local NE and the adjacent node must not carry ASON services. l The ASON Clock is disabled for the NE.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click Query to view the current enabling status of the ASON feature. Step 3 Set ASON Feature to Enabled.

NOTE

Set the ASON Feature to Disabled to disable the ASON feature.

Step 4 Click Apply. After you confirm the operation twice, a prompt is displayed indicating that the operation was successful. After you disable the ASON feature, upload the NE data to keep the consistency of data between the U2000 and the NE. For relevant operations, refer to 1.3.5 Uploading NE Configuration Data. ----End

1.3.5 Uploading NE Configuration Data


After the ASON software of an NE is enabled, the ASON NE automatically generates data on the NE. Considering that the data dynamically changes as the system runs, you can upload data to the U2000 to ensure that the data on the U2000 is consistent with that on the NE. Do not use the U2000 to initialize the ASON NE or download data to the ASON NE.

Prerequisite
l l
1-38

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The NE must be created successfully.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > NE Configuration Data Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select one or more NEs in the lower-left pane, and click .

Step 3 Select one or more NEs in the Configuration Data Management List, and click Upload. Step 4 In the Confirm dialog box, click OK to start the upload. Step 5 In the Operation Result dialog box, click Close. ----End

1.3.6 Enable the ASON Feature of a Board


In the case of an ASON NE, the ASON feature of the optical interface board of the STM-1 or STM-4 level is disabled by default. The boards of the two levels cannot be used to create an ASON service. To create an ASON service by using the boards of the two levels, you need to enable the ASON features of the boards. The ASON feature of the optical interface board of the STM-16 or STM-64 level, however, is enabled by default. You can also disable the ASON features of the boards of the two levels as required.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Feature Management from the Function Tree. Click the Board ASON Feature Management tab. Step 2 Click Query to view the current ASON Feature status of the board. Step 3 Select the port at which the ASON feature is to be disabled. Double-click the Status column and choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
NOTE

If you need to disable the ASON feature of a board, choose Disable.

Step 4 Click Apply. The Operation Result dialog box is displayed indicating the operation result. Step 5 Click Close.
NOTE

If the Operation Result dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation fails. You can click Detail to view failure causes.

----End

1.3.7 Creating Domains for an ASON Network


The U2000 manages an ASON network based on ASON domains. Usually, ASON domains are automatically created. If for some reason, there are NEs that fail to be synchronized to the ASON domain during the NE upload, you can create an ASON domain and assign the ASON NEs that belong to the same ASON network to the ASON domain.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-39

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher. The ASON NE must be configured and does not belong to any domain.

Background Information
l l An ASON domain is an ASON network composed of interconnected ASON NEs. The first ASON NE created on the U2000 is automatically assigned to the default domain.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Step 2 ASON NEs that do not belong to any domain are displayed under root of the Object Tree. Rightclick an NE and choose Create Domain. Step 3 In the Domain Attributes dialog box, enter the Current Name and select the Primary NE.

Step 4 Click OK. The domain is successfully created. ----End

1.3.8 Synchronizing ASON NEs


By communicating with the primary NE, the U2000 is kept synchronous with an ASON network and automatically discovers other ASON NEs in the network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The primary NE must exist.

Background Information
l If one or more ASON NEs are added to or deleted from the ASON network, you need to synchronize NEs and get the changed network topology.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1-40

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

If the node ID of an NE is modified manually, you need to re-synchronize the ASON network topology on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Click the ASON NE tab.

Step 2 Select a domain in the Object Tree and all ASON NEs in the domain are shown in the list. Step 3 Click Synchronize NE. The U2000 searches for the NEs in the ASON domain. If an ASON NE that is not created on U2000 is detected, add it to the NE to Be Created tab. Step 4 If you want to create a detected NE on the U2000, click in the Creation Flag field. Enter the user name and password.

NOTE

l If the U2000 uses the same user name and password to log in to all ASON NEs in the domain, check the Use the same password networkwide check box, and enter the user name and password. l If you want to upload the NE data after creating the NE, check the Upload after created check box.

Step 5 Click Apply. The Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. The Confirm dialog box is displayed. Step 6 Click OK. A progress bar is displayed, showing the uploading progress. ----End

1.3.9 Automatically Creating Fibers According to TE Link


An ASON network can automatically discover TE links. The U2000 can create fibers between NEs according to the TE links.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher. The ASON network is running normally.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 The list shows all links on the U2000. View Component information of each link. Step 3 Select a TE link for the fiber you want to create. Click Maintenance and choose Create Fiber. Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-41

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

The fibers created according to TE links are the fibers between NEs. After the fiber(s) is/are created successfully, view them on the Main Topology.

----End

1.3.10 Setting the Primary NE or Secondary NE


In an ASON network, each ASON NE is capable of obtaining the networkwide topology information. The primary NE is the ASON NE that represents the ASON to communicate with the U2000. It obtains the information of the ASON control plane and reports ASON events to the U2000. To improve the reliability, another NE can be set as the standby of the primary NE. If the primary NE fails, the secondary NE takes over to communicate with the U2000. Usually, you can select the GNE as the primary NE or as the secondary NE to avoid waste of the ECC bandwidth.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and its data must be uploaded to the U2000.

Background Information
The U2000 only needs to communicate with one NE in an ASON network. This NE is called the communication NE. It is the NE that represents the ASON network to communicate with the U2000. Usually, the communication NE is the primary NE. When the primary NE fails, the secondary NE becomes the communication NE. If both the primary and secondary NEs fail, the system automatically selects an ASON NE as the communication NE. You can set only one primary NE and one secondary NE in an ASON domain.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Click the ASON NE tab.

Step 2 Select a domain in the Object Tree and all ASON NEs in the domain are shown in the list. Step 3 Select an NE and set it to Primary in the Node Type column. Step 4 Click Apply to apply the settings. ----End

1.3.11 Setting Control Plane Parameters


You can set the control plane parameters of an ASON NE. The parameters contain the bandwidth load, bandwidth weight, distance weight, and hop weight.
1-42 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher. The ASON NE must be created and configured.

Procedure
l For an ASON NE whose ASON version is 5.51.05.10 or 5.99.2.10: 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Control Plane Parameters from the Function Tree. Click Query to query the route computation policy from the NE. Set the Route Computation Policy field and complete the rest information.

NOTE

l The route computation policy has the following parameters: Bandwidth Load, Bandwidth Weight, Distance Weight, Hop Weight. l It is recommended to keep the default settings. The default settings are as follows: bandwidth load: 0. Bandwidth weight: 50. Distance weight: 50. Hop weight: 0.

4. l 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7.

Click Apply to completed the setting. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Control Plane Parameters from the Function Tree. Click the Protocol Parameters tab. Click Query to query the protocol parameters from the NE. Double-click Revertive Rerouting Reversion Time(s) and enter the time as required. Default value: 600. Value range: 600 to 65535. Click Apply. Click the Route Calculate Strategy tab. Click Query to query the route calculation strategy from the NE. Set a value in the Route Calculate Strategy field. Complete the other information.
NOTE

For an ASON NE whose ASON version is earlier than 5.99.2.10:

l The route computation policy has the following parameters: Bandwidth Load, Bandwidth Weight, Distance Weight, Hop Weight. l It is recommended to keep the default settings. The default settings are as follows: bandwidth load: 0. Bandwidth weight: 50. Distance weight: 50. Hop weight: 0.

8. l 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Click Apply to completed the setting.. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Control Plane Parameters from the Function Tree. Click Query to query the parameters from the NE. Double-click Rerouting Delay(ms) and enter the time as required. Value range: 50 to 600000. Click Apply. Click the Route Calculate Strategy tab. Click Query to query the route calculation strategy from the NE.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-43

For an ASON NE whose ASON version is later than 5.99.2.10:

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

7.

Click Route Strategy and choose a mode from the drop-down list.
NOTE

The route computation policy has the following parameters: Bandwidth Load, Bandwidth Weight, Distance Weight, Hop Weight. The five modes of route strategy are as follows: l Load Balancing Mode: Bandwidth Load: 0. Bandwidth Weight: 50. Distance Weight: 0. Hop Weight: 0. l Shortest Distance Mode: Bandwidth Load: 0. Bandwidth Weight: 0. Distance Weight: 50. Hop Weight: 0. l Minimum Hop Count Mode: Bandwidth Load: 0. Bandwidth Weight: 0. Distance Weight: 0. Hop Weight: 50. l Integrated Constraint Mode: Bandwidth Load: 0. Bandwidth Weight: 50. Distance Weight: 50. Hop Weight: 0. l Custom Mode: you set the parameter of route strategy as you need. It is recommended that you keep the default settings. The default settings are as follows: bandwidth load: 0. Bandwidth weight: 50. Distance weight: 50. Hop weight: 0.

8. ----End

Click Apply to completed the setting..

1.3.12 Viewing ASON NE Software Version


Different ASON software versions provide different functions. By viewing the version of the ASON software running on an NE, you can know the ASON feature of the NE. This help you to configure, manage, maintain and troubleshoot the ASON NE.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. This function applies to ASON NEs.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Click the ASON NE tab. Step 2 Select the desired domain in the Object Tree and click are displayed in the list. Step 3 View the ASON NE software version in the Version. For example, 5.99.7.1. ----End . All ASON NEs in the domain

1.4 Managing the ASON Protocol


After the ASON software is enabled, the default ASON protocols are configured for the NE. After the ASON topology is created, you can set again the ASON protocols you need to facilitate the management of ASON link resources and ASON services.
1-44 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Precautions

CAUTION
l Usually, you do not need to modify the protocol configurations. l You can modify the protocol configurations when the ASON networking is a special one, or when a higher security is required. 1.4.1 Modifying the LMP Discovery Type There are two types of LMP discovery. One is by using the J0 byte (default). The other one is by using the D4-D12 bytes. When a REG NE is between two ASON NEs, you need to modify the LMP discovery type for the corresponding boards of the two ASON NEs. That is, use D4D12 bytes. 1.4.2 Querying the LMP Discovery Type You can query the overhead bytes that are used by the LMP for the system to automatically discover TE links. Currently only the D4-D12 bytes are used. They are used for the communication between NEs. 1.4.3 Disabling the LMP Protocol Usually it is not allowed to disable the LMP except in the following two cases. One is when an ASON NE is connected with a traditional NE that is incapable of transparent transmission. The other one is when an ASON NE has an optical interface that does not connect any fiber. In these two cases, you can disable the LMP to release idle resources for a better resource allocation. 1.4.4 Disabling the OSPF Protocol Usually it is not allowed to disable the OSPF protocol except in the following two cases. One is when an ASON NE is connected with a traditional NE that is incapable of transparent transmission. The other one is when an ASON NE has an optical interface that does not connect any fiber. In the two cases, you can disable OSPF to release idle resources for a better resource allocation. 1.4.5 Encrypting the OSPF Protocol You can query and set the OSPF protocol authentication and encrypt the OSPF protocol to ensure the security of the ASON network. 1.4.6 Setting the OSPF TE Link Flood Threshold The TE link flood threshold defines the frequency of the flood on the TE link. After the network fault is cleared, the TE link data changes for times as the NE data upload or synchronization is performed. When the change times reaches the threshold, the flood takes place on the TE link. 1.4.7 Encrypting RSVP To ensure the security of the ASON network, you can encrypt the Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP). The encryption operation needs to be performed for two neighboring NEs. Two neighboring NEs can implement protocol interworking only if the two NEs have the same authentication type and authentication key. 1.4.8 Creating Out-Fiber Control Channels The out-fiber control channel realizes the interconnection between two ASON domains. You can use an Ethernet cable to connect two edge NEs of two ASON domains, and then manually create an out-fiber control channel on the U2000. In this way, the communication between the two ASON domains is realized at the control plane.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-45

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.4.1 Modifying the LMP Discovery Type


There are two types of LMP discovery. One is by using the J0 byte (default). The other one is by using the D4-D12 bytes. When a REG NE is between two ASON NEs, you need to modify the LMP discovery type for the corresponding boards of the two ASON NEs. That is, use D4D12 bytes.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

Service Requirements
If the service requirement is shown in Figure 1-13, where NE1-NE4 are ASON NEs and NE5 is a REG NE, you need to modify the LMP discovery type for the boards of NE3 and NE4. Figure 1-13 LMP discovery mode
NE1 NE4

NE5

NE2

NE3 : ASON NE :REGl NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-14 shows how the boards are configured for the case of the previously illustrated service requirements.

1-46

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-14 Board configuration of NE3 and NE4

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose ASON > Link Management Protocol from the Function Tree. Click LMP Auto Discovery Type tab. Step 2 Click Query to query the LMP automatic discovery type. Step 3 Double-click Configuration Mode to set the LMP automatic discovery type. For example, set the discovery type of 11-N2SL64 on both NE3 and NE4 to DCC. Step 4 Click Apply. Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box. Step 5 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Control Link Management from the main menu. Step 6 Click Synchronize. Check whether the control links between NEs are normal. Step 7 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 8 Click Synchronize. Check whether the TE links between NEs are normal. ----End

1.4.2 Querying the LMP Discovery Type


You can query the overhead bytes that are used by the LMP for the system to automatically discover TE links. Currently only the D4-D12 bytes are used. They are used for the communication between NEs.

Prerequisite
l l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-47

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, click the NE and choose ASON > Link Management Protocol from the Function Tree. Click LMP Auto Discovery Type tab. Step 2 Click Query to query the LMP automatic discovery type. ----End

1.4.3 Disabling the LMP Protocol


Usually it is not allowed to disable the LMP except in the following two cases. One is when an ASON NE is connected with a traditional NE that is incapable of transparent transmission. The other one is when an ASON NE has an optical interface that does not connect any fiber. In these two cases, you can disable the LMP to release idle resources for a better resource allocation.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information

WARNING
If the LMP is disabled, the ASON feature of the corresponding optical interface is disabled, which severely affects ASON services. Hence, do not disable the LMP if not necessary.

Procedure
l For NG SDH and OCS series equipments. 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Click the ASON Protocol Management tab. Click Query to query the ASON protocol information from the NE. Select the port at which the LMP is to be disabled. Double-click the LMP Protocol Status column and choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
NOTE

If you need to enable the LMP, choose Enabled.

4. 5. 6. l 1. 2. 3.

Click Apply. A confirm dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. The operation result dialog box is displayed, click Close. Click Query. Query LMP protocol status from the NE. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Click the LMP Protocol Status tab. Click Query to query the ASON protocol information from the NE Select the port at which the LMP is to be disabled. Double-click the LMP Protocol Status column and choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

For OptiX OSN 9560.

1-48

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management
NOTE

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

If you need to enable the LMP, choose Enabled.

4. 5. 6. ----End

Click Apply. A confirm dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. The operation result dialog box is displayed, click Close. Click Query. Query LMP protocol status from the NE.

1.4.4 Disabling the OSPF Protocol


Usually it is not allowed to disable the OSPF protocol except in the following two cases. One is when an ASON NE is connected with a traditional NE that is incapable of transparent transmission. The other one is when an ASON NE has an optical interface that does not connect any fiber. In the two cases, you can disable OSPF to release idle resources for a better resource allocation.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information

WARNING
If the OSPF protocol is disabled, the ASON feature of the corresponding optical interface is disabled, which severely affects ASON services. Hence, do not disable the OSPF protocol if not necessary.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click the ASON Protocol Management tab. Click Query to query the ASON protocol information from the NE. Step 3 Select the port at which the OSPF protocol is to be disabled. Double-click the OSPF Protocol Status column. Choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
NOTE

If you need to enable the OSPF protocol, choose Enabled.

Step 4 Click Apply. A confirm dialog box is displayed. Step 5 Click Yes. The operation result dialog box is displayed, click Close. Step 6 Click Query. Queries OSPF protocol status from the NE. ----End
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-49

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.4.5 Encrypting the OSPF Protocol


You can query and set the OSPF protocol authentication and encrypt the OSPF protocol to ensure the security of the ASON network.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information
The encryption conditions for an NE and its remote NE must be the same.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > OSPF Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click the OSPF Protocol Authentication tab. Step 3 Click Query. Step 4 Double-click Authentication Mode or Authentication Key to set the two parameters.
NOTE

l The following three options are available for Authentication Mode: Unconfigured, Plain Text Password Authentication and MD5 Encryption Authentication. l When the value is Plain Text Password Authentication, the authentication is performed based on the specified password. In this case, the Authentication Key must be a string of a maximum of eight characters. l When the value is MD5 Encryption Authentication, the authentication is performed based on the password obtained by using the MD5 encryption algorithm. In this case, the Authentication Key must be a non-empty string of a maximum of 64 characters.

Step 5 Click Apply. A confirm dialog box is displayed. Step 6 Click OK. ----End

1.4.6 Setting the OSPF TE Link Flood Threshold


The TE link flood threshold defines the frequency of the flood on the TE link. After the network fault is cleared, the TE link data changes for times as the NE data upload or synchronization is performed. When the change times reaches the threshold, the flood takes place on the TE link.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information
l l You need to set a proper flood threshold. If the value is too low, network congestions may happen. If the value is too high, the network data may not be synchronous. It is recommended that you use the default value of the U2000. By default, the threshold value is 100, and the hold-off time is 3s.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1-50

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > OSPF Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click the OSPF TE Link Flood Threshold tab to set the parameters. Step 3 Click Query. Step 4 For a TE link, double-click Trigger Condition, Threshold and Delay Time(s) to set their respective values. Click Apply. ----End

1.4.7 Encrypting RSVP


To ensure the security of the ASON network, you can encrypt the Resource Reservation Protocol (RSVP). The encryption operation needs to be performed for two neighboring NEs. Two neighboring NEs can implement protocol interworking only if the two NEs have the same authentication type and authentication key.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The encryption conditions for an NE and its remote NE must be the same.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > RSVP Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click Query. Step 3 Click New. The RSVP Authentication Create dialog box is displayed. Step 4 Set Neighboring Node, Type and Key.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-51

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l The following three options are available for Authentication Mode: Plain Text Password Authentication and MD5 Encryption Authentication. l When the value is Plain Text Password Authentication, the authentication is performed based on the specified password. In this case, the Authentication Key must be a string of a maximum of eight characters. l When the value is MD5 Encryption Authentication, the authentication is performed based on the password obtained by using the MD5 encryption algorithm. In this case, the Authentication Key must be a non-empty string of a maximum of 64 characters.

Step 5 Click Apply.


NOTE

After the RSVP authentication is successfully created. You can double-click the Authentication Mode column and change the authentication type. Click Apply. The dialog box displayed, prompt the service survivability may be affected, click Yes to apply the change.

----End

1.4.8 Creating Out-Fiber Control Channels


The out-fiber control channel realizes the interconnection between two ASON domains. You can use an Ethernet cable to connect two edge NEs of two ASON domains, and then manually create an out-fiber control channel on the U2000. In this way, the communication between the two ASON domains is realized at the control plane.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network is running normally.

Service Requirements
You can create an out-fiber control channel as shown in Figure 1-15. In this example, NE3 in the ASON001 domain and NE6 in the ASON002 domain are connected by an Ethernet line. NE3 and NE6 are connected to NE9 through fibers. Figure 1-15 Creating out-fiber control channels
NE1 NE4 NE5 NE8

NE2

NE3 ASON001 NE9

NE6

NE7 ASON002 : ASON NE : Traditional NE : Fiber : Ethernet link

1-52

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

NOTE

You need to create an out-fiber control channel on the NE that connects the two ASON domains.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Link Management Protocol from the Function Tree. Step 2 Click the LMP Control Channel tab. Click Query to query control channels of the link management protocol from the NE. Step 3 Click New and the Create Control Channel dialog box is displayed. Enter a value in the Remote Address and Next Hop Address fields respectively.

NOTE

The remote address and the next hop address are the node ID of the remote NE. l As shown in Figure 1-15, if only one Ethernet link exists between the source and the sink, the two addresses are consistent. l If a hub exists on the Ethernet link between the source and the sink, the two addresses are consistent. l If a switch exists on the Ethernet link between the source and the sink, the remote address is the node ID of the sink NE and the next hop address is the IP address of the switch. l If a router exists on the Ethernet link between the source and the sink, the remote address is the node ID of the sink NE and the next hop address is the IP address of the router. l If a local area network (LAN) exists on the Ethernet link between the source and the sink, the remote address is the node ID of the sink NE and the next hop address is the IP address of the LAN that connects to the source NE.

For example, if NE3 is the source, the remote address and the next hop address are the node ID of NE6. Step 4 Click Apply for the settings to take effect. Step 5 In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > OSPF Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Step 6 Click the OSPF IP Address Management tab. Step 7 Click Query. Step 8 Find the source or sink NE of the newly created out-fiber control channel. Double-click IP or Mask to set the parameters.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-53

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 9 Click Apply. Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box. Step 10 Creating a Virtual TE Link. If NE3 is the source, you need to create the virtual TE link between NE3 and NE6. ----End

1.5 Managing ASON Clock Subnet


Clock subnet is classified into ASON clock subnet and traditional clock subnet. Before configuring ASON services, you need to create a clock subnet to ensure that a consistent clock tracing relation is created for all NEs in the ASON network.

Background Information
ASON NEs support the traditional clock trace mode and the ASON clock trace mode. In an ASON domain, you can set some or all of the ASON NEs to the ASON clock trace mode, to form an ASON clock subnet. In the ASON clock subnet, each ASON NE automatically traces the best clock source. The clock is then automatically traced and switched, thus avoiding the clock interlocking. This simplifies the clock configuration. In an ASON domain with many ASON NEs, several ASON clock subnets should be created if more than 20 ASON NEs are on the clock tracing link in a clock subnet. Each ASON clock subnet generates its own clock tracing relation to trace the PRCs inside the subnet. In each ASON clock subnet, change of the PRCs and links does not affect the clock tracing relation in other ASON clock subnets. Generally, you need to create only one ASON clock subnet in one ASON domain. 1.5.1 Creating an ASON Clock Subnet In an ASON clock subnet, the clock tracing relation is formed based on the automatic tracing of clocks and thus need not be configured on a per-NE basis. 1.5.2 Converting a Preconfigured ASON Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet If the preconfiguration mode is selected during creation of a clock subnet, the clock tracing mode in this subnet is traditional and thus requires a manual configuration. You can convert a preconfigured ASON clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet. 1.5.3 Converting a Traditional Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet If the clock trace mode of a clock subnet is traditional, you need to manually convert the traditional clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet. 1.5.4 Managing a Hybrid Network Composed of an ASON Clock Subnet and a Traditional Clock Subnet In the case of a hybrid network composed of an ASON clock subnet and a traditional clock subnet, if the SSM mode of the traditional clock subnet changes, you need to adjust the ASON PRC of the ASON clock subnet accordingly. 1.5.5 Setting the Clock Fault Recover Time When a fault occurs, the ASON clock is switched. When the original link is restored, the ASON clock can be used only after the WTR time for a clock upon a fault elapses.

1.5.1 Creating an ASON Clock Subnet


In an ASON clock subnet, the clock tracing relation is formed based on the automatic tracing of clocks and thus need not be configured on a per-NE basis.
1-54 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-16, NE1 to NE4 are ASON NEs while NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. It is required that NE1 to NE4 form an ASON clock subnet. The ASON clock tracing mode needs to be enabled. NE5 and NE6 provide primary reference clock sources, which contain the clock quality information. Compared with NE5, NE6 is of a higher priority. In this way, the ASON clock subnet first traces the primary reference clock source of a higher quality. If the primary reference clock source of NE5 and NE6 are of the same quality, the ASON clock subnet traces NE6 as per the priority. In addition, some changes are made to the fiber between NE2 and NE4. Therefore, services and clocks should not travel through this link. Figure 1-16 ASON clock subnet
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

NE2

NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-17 shows the board configuration of NE1 to NE4. The 12-N1SL16 of NE2 is connected to NE6 and the 12-N1SL16 of NE3 is connected to NE5.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-55

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-17 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

PIU

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

PIU

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Planning for the Clock Subnet


Table 1-11 provides the clock subnet planning information. Table 1-11 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4 Attributes Clock Subnet ID ASON NE SSM mode Primary reference clock source Priority Relay Interface mode Clock Subnet 1 NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 Standard Clock Mode NE2-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) 1 (high) No relay NE4 cannot directly trace NE2 NE3-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) 2 (low)

NOTE

The clock quality outputted by NE5 and NE6 is G.811.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Clock Subnet Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click New.
1-56 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 3 Enter the following information in the dialog box: l Subnet ID: 1 l NE: NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 l SSM Mode: Standard Clock Mode l PRC ID: NE2-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) and NE3-12-N1SL6-1 (SDH-1)

Step 4 Click OK. Step 5 Click Query in the ASON Clock Subnet Management window. Step 6 Select PRC Management to query the state of the primary reference clock source. Step 7 Select Interface Mode Management. Set the interface mode of the NE4-7-N2SL64-1 to Detection of the Clock Quantity Disabled. Step 8 Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. Step 9 In the Clock View, right-click Search Clock Link to view the clock tracing relation within the subnet. ----End

1.5.2 Converting a Preconfigured ASON Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet
If the preconfiguration mode is selected during creation of a clock subnet, the clock tracing mode in this subnet is traditional and thus requires a manual configuration. You can convert a preconfigured ASON clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-57

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-18, NE1 to NE4 are ASON NEs. These ASON NEs work in the traditional clock mode. NE1 traces the external 2 Mbit/s clock source. NE2, NE3, and NE4 trace NE1. The 2 Mbit/s external clock source of NE1 contains clock quality information. The clock quality is G.811 clock. The clock mode of NE1 to NE4 need be modified to ASON clock mode. An ASON clock subnet then need be created and the standard SSM protocol need be enabled. The 2 Mbit/s clock source of NE1 is taken as the primary reference clock source for the ASON clock subnet. Figure 1-18 Traditional Clock Subnet
NE1

2Mbit/s external clock source

NE2

NE4

NE3

Board Configuration
Figure 1-19 shows the board configuration of NE1 to NE4. Figure 1-19 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

PIU

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

PIU

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

1-58

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Planning for the Clock Subnet


Table 1-12 provides the new clock subnet planning information. Table 1-12 Planning for the new clock subnet Attributes Clock Subnet ID ASON NE SSM mode Primary reference clock source Priority Relay Interface mode Clock Subnet 2 NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 Standard Clock Mode NE1-External Clock1 1 No relay None

Precautions
NOTE

The operation of converting a preconfigured ASON clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet is similar to that of creating an ASON clock subnet. In the former case, however, you need to select a preconfigured subnet.

Follow the steps below to modify a traditional clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Clock Subnet Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click New. Step 3 Enter the following information in the dialog box: l Subnet ID: 2 l NE: NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 l SSM Mode: Standard Clock Mode l PRC ID: NE1-External Clock1

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-59

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 4 Select Preconfigured Subnet and click OK. Step 5 Click Query. Step 6 Select PRC Management to query the state of the primary reference clock source. Step 7 Right-click Clock Subnet1 from the Subnet Management Tree. Select Migrate to ASON Clock Subnet.

Step 8 A dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. Step 9 A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 10 Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. Step 11 In the Clock View, right-click Search Clock Link to view the clock tracing relation within the subnet. ----End

1-60

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.5.3 Converting a Traditional Clock Subnet into an ASON Clock Subnet


If the clock trace mode of a clock subnet is traditional, you need to manually convert the traditional clock subnet into an ASON clock subnet.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-20, NE1, NE2, NE3, and NE4 are ASON NEs that work in the traditional clock trace mode, and NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. It is required that NE1 to NE4 form an ASON clock subnet. The ASON clock tracing mode needs to be enabled. NE5 and NE6 provide primary reference clock sources, which contain the clock quality information. Compared with NE5, NE6 is of a higher priority. In this way, the ASON clock subnet first traces the primary reference clock source of a higher quality. If the primary reference clock source of NE5 and NE6 are of the same quality, the ASON clock subnet traces NE6 as per the priority. Figure 1-20 ASON clock subnet
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

NE2

NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-21 shows the board configuration of NE1 to NE4. The 12-N1SL16 of NE2 is connected to NE6 and the 12-N1SL16 of NE3 is connected to NE5.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-61

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-21 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

PIU

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

PIU

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Clock Subnet Planning


Table 1-13 shows the planning of a new clock subnet. Table 1-13 Board configuration of NE1 to NE4 Attribute Clock Subnet ID ASON NE SSM Mode PRC PRC Priority Relay Interface Mode Clock Subnet 1 NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 Standard clock mode NE2-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) 1 (high) No relay Automatic detection of the clock quantity NE3-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) 2 (low)

NOTE

The clock quality outputted by NE5 and NE6 is G.811.

Follow a different procedure according to the scenario.

Procedure
l Scenario 1: The ASON NEs work in the traditional clock trace mode and Stop SSM Mode is enabled.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1-62

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1. 2. 3.

Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Clock Subnet Management from the main menu. Click New. Enter the following information in the dialog box: Subnet ID: 1 NE: NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 SSM Mode: Standard Clock Mode PRC ID: NE2-12-N1SL16-1 (SDH-1) and NE3-12-N1SL6-1 (SDH-1)

4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9.

Click OK. Click Query in the ASON Clock Subnet Management window. Click the PRC Management tab and query the PRC status. Click New. In the Add PRC window, select the desired Output PRC or Input PRC according to the priority. Click OK and navigate to the PRC Management window. Click Apply. Select a PRC and right-click PRC Level to set the PRC quality. For example, select NE2 as the PRC and set the quality to G.811 Clock Signal.

10. Click OK in the prompt. 11. Click Close in the operation result dialog box. 12. Click Apply. or to set the priority. 13. Select a PRC and click For example, set the priority of NE2-12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) to 1 and the priority of NE3-12-N1SL6-1(SDH-1) to 2. 14. Click Apply. 15. Select Interface Mode Management and click Query. Then, set all the interface modes to Automatic Detection of the Clock Quantity.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-63

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

16. Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. 17. In the Clock View, right-click Search Clock Link to view the clock tracing relation within the subnet. l Scenario 2: The ASON NEs work in the traditional clock trace mode and Standard SSM Mode is enabled. 1. 2. 3. l Create an ASON clock subnet. For details, refer to Steps 1 through 5 in scenario 1. Configure the PRC priority. For details, refer to Steps 6, 13, and 14 in scenario 1. Query the networkwide clock synchronization status. For details, refer to Steps 16 through 17 in scenario 1.

Scenario 3: The ASON NEs work in the traditional clock trace mode and Extended SSM Mode is enabled. 1. 2. Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. In the Clock View, right-click an NE and choose Configure Clock from the shortcut menu. For example, select NE2 and NE3 to set the clock quality. Choose Configuration > Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration in the NE explorer. Click Start Standard SSM Protocol. Click Apply. The standard SSM protocol must be started for all ASON NEs in the clock subnet. Create an ASON clock subnet. For details, refer to Steps 1 through 5 in scenario 1. Configure the PRC priority. For details, refer to Steps 6, 13, and 14 in scenario 1. Query the networkwide clock synchronization status. For details, refer to Steps 16 through 17 in scenario 1.

3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. ----End

1.5.4 Managing a Hybrid Network Composed of an ASON Clock Subnet and a Traditional Clock Subnet
In the case of a hybrid network composed of an ASON clock subnet and a traditional clock subnet, if the SSM mode of the traditional clock subnet changes, you need to adjust the ASON PRC of the ASON clock subnet accordingly.

Configuration Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-22, NE1, NE2, NE3, and NE4 are ASON NEs that work in the ASON clock trace mode, and NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs that work in the traditional clock trace mode. The clock subnet of the ASON NEs is an ASON clock subnet. NE2 and NE3 provide PRCs but NE2 has a higher priority. The clock subnet of the traditional NEs is a traditional clock subnet. NE5 and NE6 provide PRCs but NE6 has a higher priority. In addition, the line clock sources provided by NE5 and NE6 contain the clock quality information.

1-64

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-22 Hybrid network composed of an ASON clock subnet and a traditional clock subnet
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

NE2

NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-23 shows the board configuration of NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4. 12-N1SL16 of NE2 connects to NE6, and 12-N1SL16 of NE3 connects to NE5. Figure 1-23 Board configuration of NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

PIU

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

PIU

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Clock Subnet Planning


Table 1-14 shows the planning of a new clock subnet.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

1-65

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-14 Clock subnet planning Attribute Clock Subnet ID ASON NE SSM Mode PRC PRC Priority Relay Interface Mode Clock Subnet 1 NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 Standard clock mode NE2-12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) 1 (high) No relay Automatic detection of the clock quality NE3-12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) 2 (low)

Follow a different procedure according to the scenario.

Procedure
l Scenario 1: The Stop SSM Mode is enabled in the traditional clock subnet. 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Clock Subnet Management from the main menu. In the Object Tree, select ASON Clock Subnet > Clock Subnet1. Click the PRC Management tab and query the PRC status. Click New. In the Add PRC window, select the desired Output PRC or Input PRC according to the priority. For example, select NE2 and NE3 as PRCs, and set the priority of NE2 to 1 and the priority of NE3 to 2. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Click OK and navigate to the PRC Management window. Click Apply. Select a PRC and right-click PRC Level to set the PRC quality. For example, select NE2 as the PRC and set the quality to G.811 Clock Signal. Click OK in the prompt. Click Close in the operation result dialog box. Click Apply. or to set the priority.

10. Select a PRC and click

For example, set the priority of NE2-12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) to 1 and the priority of NE3-12-N1SL6-1(SDH-1) to 2. 11. Click Apply. 12. Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. 13. In the Clock View, right-click Search Clock Link to view the clock tracing relation within the subnet. l Scenario 2: The Standard SSM Mode is enabled in the traditional clock subnet. 1. 2.
1-66

Set the PRC. For details, refer to Steps 1 through 5 in scenario 1. Configure the PRC priority. For details, refer to Steps 10 through 11 in scenario 1.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

3. l

Query the networkwide clock synchronization status. For details, refer to Steps 12 through 13 in scenario 1. Open the main topology, click the Current View drop-list, select Clock View. In the Clock View, right-click an NE and choose Configure Clock from the shortcut menu. For example, select NE5 and NE6 to set the clock quality. Choose Configuration > Clock > Clock Subnet Configuration in the NE explorer. Click Start Standard SSM Protocol. Click Apply. Set the PRC. For details, refer to Steps 1 through 5 in scenario 1. Configure the PRC priority. For details, refer to Steps 10 through 11 in scenario 1. Query the networkwide clock synchronization status. For details, refer to Steps 12 through 13 in scenario 1.

Scenario 3: The Extended SSM Mode is enabled in the traditional clock subnet. 1. 2.

3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. ----End

1.5.5 Setting the Clock Fault Recover Time


When a fault occurs, the ASON clock is switched. When the original link is restored, the ASON clock can be used only after the WTR time for a clock upon a fault elapses.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON clock subnet must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Clock Subnet Management from the main menu. Step 2 In Subnet Management Tree, select the required ASON clock subnet. Step 3 Click the Subnet Attribute tab and click Query. Step 4 Select the required NE, double-click the Clock Fault Recover Time field, and enter a value for the WTR time.
NOTE

The WTR time for a clock upon a fault can be set to 60 to 900 seconds. The default value is 60 seconds.

Step 5 Click Apply. ----End

1.6 Managing Link Resources


ASON is capable of automatically switching optical network connections under the control of the signaling network. It dynamically allocates network resources as required. As the network is growing larger, a more reasonable way of resource management is required to make the most of the network resources and to improve the network efficiency. Link resource management is
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-67

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

one aspect of resource management. In an actual network, thousands of connections may exist between two nodes, while each connection may be composed of multiple data links. Usually, there are links that have the same attributes according to a route protocol. These links are regarded as a whole, which is known as the traffic engineer link (TE link), serving as the processing object of the route information. 1.6.1 Synchronizing Control Links Networkwide By synchronizing the control links, the control link data on the U2000 is kept consistent with that on the NEs of the ASON network. 1.6.2 Synchronizing TE Links You can synchronize the TE links. The U2000 queries link resources in the network by the primary NE to keep the TE link data on the U2000 consistent with the ASON data. 1.6.3 Viewing TE Links You can view the ASON TE link information on the U2000. This helps you to configure or maintain TE links. 1.6.4 Configuring the Link Distance You can set the link distance on the U2000 for route calculation. If you want to use the physical distance between NEs as one element for the route calculation, you need to set the TE link distance according to the actual physical distance. 1.6.5 Setting the Custom Cost of the TE Link You can set the custom cost of the TE link on the U2000 for route calculation. You must set the custom cost and custom cost weight at the same time to enable the parameters. 1.6.6 Setting the Usage Threshold of Fiber Resources The usage threshold of the fiber resources can be set according to the requirements of the customer. When the fiber resource occupancy exceeds the usage threshold, the system reports the CP_TELINK_EXHAUST alarm. 1.6.7 Creating an SRLG Fibers in the same optical cable have the same risk. If the cable is cut, all fibers are also cut. During the service rerouting, services should not be rerouted to the link that belongs to the same shared risk link group (SRLG). Therefore, you need to set the same SRLG value for TE links that share the same risks in the network. 1.6.8 Querying VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status When you query the VC4 timeslot occupation status, you can query the following status of the VC4 slot: timeslot occupation status, reservation status, and MSP switching status. Based on the specific VC4 timeslot status, you can set reserved timeslots for an NE. 1.6.9 Querying the Information About the Timeslots on the Link Sections The TE link that is configured with MSP is divided into several sections. The sections of the TE link can be of the working, protection, non-protection attribute, or virtual link. You can query Protection, Switching Status, Total Timeslots, Timeslots Available for ASON, and Idle Timeslots for each link section. 1.6.10 Setting Resource Reservation You can configure the board ports and timeslots that are reserved for the permanent connections on an ASON NE. Both ASON trails and permanent connections can be created in an ASON network. Link resource reservation means that some timeslots of a link are reserved for the creation of permanent connections. The reserved timeslots cannot be used when ASON trails are created and or rerouted. 1.6.11 Creating a Virtual Interfaces
1-68 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

You can partition a interface into several virtual interface with different rate by U2000, then you can create TE link on the virtual interface. 1.6.12 Creating a Virtual TE Link Without a TE link, ASON services cannot be created between a traditional NE and an ASON NE. A virtual TE link, however, uses traditional resources to realize the creation and protection for ASON services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs. You can directly create ASON services on TE links. 1.6.13 Creating a TE Link Based on Virtual Interfaces This topic describes how to create a traffic engineering (TE) link based on virtual interfaces. When the port rates on the source and the sink are different, you can create a TE link based on virtual interfaces. Such TE links are available for creating services. 1.6.14 Deleting an Interrupted TE Link Manually When a TE link is interrupted, the TE link is saved on the U2000 and the link status is Interrupted. This facilitates fault locating. You can also manually delete the interrupted link.

1.6.1 Synchronizing Control Links Networkwide


By synchronizing the control links, the control link data on the U2000 is kept consistent with that on the NEs of the ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network must be running properly.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Control Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click Synchronize. In the Synchronize dialog box displayed, choose Domain. Step 3 Click Synchronize.
NOTE

After the synchronization is complete, all the information about the control links are displayed in the list.

----End

1.6.2 Synchronizing TE Links


You can synchronize the TE links. The U2000 queries link resources in the network by the primary NE to keep the TE link data on the U2000 consistent with the ASON data.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network is running normally.

Background Information
In current ASON software versions, one TE link contains only one component link. In this sense, to synchronize a TE link is the same as to synchronize a component link.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-69

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click Synchronize. In the Synchronize dialog box displayed, choose Domain. Step 3 Click Synchronize.
NOTE

After the synchronization is complete, all the information about the TE links is displayed in the list.

----End

1.6.3 Viewing TE Links


You can view the ASON TE link information on the U2000. This helps you to configure or maintain TE links.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network is running normally.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 The list shows all links on the U2000. View the information of each link.
NOTE

A TE link is unidirectional. So a two-fiber bidirectional fiber is displayed as two TE links.

Step 3 Select a TE link. The component links of the TE link are displayed in the following table. Step 4 Select one or more TE links. The total bandwidth utilization is displayed in the left side of the button bar in the middle of the window. Step 5 Optional: Select the desired bandwidth unit from the Bandwidth Units drop-down list, for example, VC4. The list is automatically refreshed and displays the link information according to the selected bandwidth unit.
NOTE

According to some standards, the bandwidth unit of TE links is kbit/s. On the U2000 you can choose a different bandwidth unit to cater for the requirements for the SDH transmission.

Step 6 Optional: Click Filter, in the Filter dialog box displayed, select the Domain, Source NE, Sink NE and OVPN Customer, and click Filter. The qualified links are shown in the list. Step 7 Optional: Click Print to export the list to Internet Explorer for printing. Step 8 Optional: Click Save As. Enter the start line number, end line number and the file name. Click OK to save the list to a file. ----End
1-70 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.6.4 Configuring the Link Distance


You can set the link distance on the U2000 for route calculation. If you want to use the physical distance between NEs as one element for the route calculation, you need to set the TE link distance according to the actual physical distance.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. TE link management is based on correct link information.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click Synchronize. In the Synchronize dialog box displayed, choose Domain. Step 3 Click Synchronize.
NOTE

After the synchronization is complete, all the information about the TE links is displayed in the list.

Step 4 Select a link, double-click the Distance(km) field, and enter a value. Step 5 Click Apply for the settings to take effect. ----End

1.6.5 Setting the Custom Cost of the TE Link


You can set the custom cost of the TE link on the U2000 for route calculation. You must set the custom cost and custom cost weight at the same time to enable the parameters.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. TE link management is based on correct link information. The ASON NE of the GCP V100R007C02 version or a later version.

Procedure
Step 1 Click Synchronize. In the Synchronize dialog box displayed, choose Domain and Payload Type. Step 2 Click Synchronize.
NOTE

After the synchronization is complete, all the information about the TE links is displayed in the list.

Step 3 Select a link, double-click the Custom Cost field, and enter a value. Or right-click the column, enter the value in the dialog box.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-71

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l The value of custom cost is 0 to 100. l If the source NE of the TE link not support the custom cost, the value is 0 and you can not set it. Namely, the route calculation not affected by this parameters.

Step 4 Click Apply for the settings to take effect. ----End

1.6.6 Setting the Usage Threshold of Fiber Resources


The usage threshold of the fiber resources can be set according to the requirements of the customer. When the fiber resource occupancy exceeds the usage threshold, the system reports the CP_TELINK_EXHAUST alarm.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network must run normally.

Procedure
Step 1 Select the NE in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. Step 2 Choose ASON > Optical Fiber Resource Threshold Management from the Function Tree. Step 3 Select the fiber. Click the Resource Threshold column and enter the planned resource usage threshold.
NOTE

The default value of Resource Threshold is 75.

Step 4 Click Apply to validate the settings. ----End

1.6.7 Creating an SRLG


Fibers in the same optical cable have the same risk. If the cable is cut, all fibers are also cut. During the service rerouting, services should not be rerouted to the link that belongs to the same shared risk link group (SRLG). Therefore, you need to set the same SRLG value for TE links that share the same risks in the network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The TE link data must be configured on the U2000.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-24. All NEs are ASON NEs. NE4 and NE5 are in the same equipment room. The fiber between NE1 and NE4, and the fiber between NE1 and NE5 are within the same cable. In this situation, the TE links of the two fibers share the same risk.
1-72 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-24 SRLG schematic diagram


Two fibers in one cable

NE1

NE4

NE5

NE2

NE3

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select the TE links. Double-click the SRLG field and enter a value. In this example, the same field value should be applied to the SRLG of the TE link between NE1 and NE4 and the one of the TE link between NE1 and NE5. Step 3 Click Apply for the settings to take effect.
NOTE

After you modify the attributes, the TE link in the opposite direction is automatically set to the same SRLG value.

----End

1.6.8 Querying VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status


When you query the VC4 timeslot occupation status, you can query the following status of the VC4 slot: timeslot occupation status, reservation status, and MSP switching status. Based on the specific VC4 timeslot status, you can set reserved timeslots for an NE.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network must be running properly.

Procedure
Step 1 To query the VC4 timeslot occupation status at the network layer, perform the following operations: 1. 2. 3. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Component Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. In the list displayed, you can view the information of all component links of the U2000. Select a link from the list, right-click and choose Query VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status. The VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status dialog box is displayed.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-73

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

4. 5.

Click Source Timeslot Status or Sink Timeslot Status. Click Query. Click Cancel.

Step 2 Optional: To query the VC4 timeslot occupation status on a per-NE basis, perform the following operations: 1. 2. In the NE Explorer, select a board that belongs to an ASON NE and choose ASON > VC4 Timeslot Occupation Status from the Function Tree. Click Query.

----End

1.6.9 Querying the Information About the Timeslots on the Link Sections
The TE link that is configured with MSP is divided into several sections. The sections of the TE link can be of the working, protection, non-protection attribute, or virtual link. You can query Protection, Switching Status, Total Timeslots, Timeslots Available for ASON, and Idle Timeslots for each link section.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.. The ASON feature must be enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Component Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the SDH Component Link Management window, click Synchronize. Step 3 Select the member link to be queried. Right-click and choose Query Link Timeslot Segmentation from the shortcut menu. Step 4 In the Query Link Timeslot Segmentation window, click Query. The information about Protection, Switching Status, Total Timeslots, Timeslots Available for ASON, and Idle Timeslots is displayed.

----End
1-74 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.6.10 Setting Resource Reservation


You can configure the board ports and timeslots that are reserved for the permanent connections on an ASON NE. Both ASON trails and permanent connections can be created in an ASON network. Link resource reservation means that some timeslots of a link are reserved for the creation of permanent connections. The reserved timeslots cannot be used when ASON trails are created and or rerouted.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON network must be running properly.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-25. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. There are services running on NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4. According to the planning, two months later, four unprotected traditional services will be created between NE5 and NE6. These services are required to pass NE3 and NE4. In this case, you need to reserve for the planned services some timeslots between NE3 and NE4 to prevent the timeslots from being occupied by rerouted ASON services. Figure 1-25 Reserved link resources
NE5 NE1 NE4

NE6 NE2 : ASON NE : Traditional NE NE3

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirements, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-26. The 11-N2SL64 of NE3 and 8-N2SL64 of NE4 are connected by fibers.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-75

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-26 Board configurations on NE3 and NE4

Procedure
Step 1 To reserve link resources at the network layer, perform the following operations: 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Component Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. The list displays all component links on the U2000. You can view the information of each component link. Set the filter criteria as required. Click Filter. Select a link in the list, right-click it and choose Set Resource Reservation from the shortcut menu. The Set Resource Reservation dialog box is displayed. For example, select a component link. l Source NE: NE3 l Source Port: 11-N2SL64-1(SDH-1) l Sink NE: NE4 l Sink Port: 8-N2SL64-1(SDH-1) Right-click the component link and choose Set Resource Reservation from the shortcut menu. 5. Set timeslots in Resource Reservation. Click Apply. For example, click timeslots 33-36 to reserve the four timeslots.
NOTE

If you want to cancel the resource reservation settings, click the reserved timeslot(s) that are configured.

6. 7.
1-76

Click Close in the Operation Result dialog box. Click Cancel in the Set Resource Reservation dialog box . The link resources are reserved.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 2 Optional: To reserve link resources on a per-NE basis, perform the following operations: 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer, select a board of an ASON NE and choose ASON > Resource Reservation Management from the Function Tree. Click Query to query the resource reservation status of the board from the NE. Select the VC4 channel to be reserved and set the reservation status to Yes. For example, set the reservation status of the channels from NE3-11-N2SL64-1(SDH-1)VC4:33 to NE3-11-N2SL64-1(SDH-1)-VC4:36 to Yes. 4. 5. Click Apply and a dialog box is displayed telling that the settings are applied. In the opposite station, repeat step a to step d to reserve link resources.

----End

1.6.11 Creating a Virtual Interfaces


You can partition a interface into several virtual interface with different rate by U2000, then you can create TE link on the virtual interface.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There is no TE link in the port. The LMP protocol on the port is disabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Disable the LMP protocol. 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer of NE1, select an NE and choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Click the ASON Protocol Management tab. Click Query to query the ASON protocol information from the NE. Select the port at which the LMP is to be disabled, e.g. 5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1). Double-click the LMP Protocol Status column and choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
NOTE

If you need to enable the LMP protocol, choose Enabled.

4. 5. 6. 7.

Click Apply. A confirmation dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. The operation result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. Click Query to query the LMP protocol status from the NE. Follow the preceding steps to disable the LMP protocol on the port 12-N2SL16-1(SDH-1) of NE4.

Step 2 Create the virtual interface. 1. 2. 3.


Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

In the NE Explorer of NE1, select a board of an ASON NE and choose ASON > ASON Link Virtual Interface Management from the Function Tree. Select the TE link whose source is NE1-5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1) and click Create Virtual Interface. The Create Virtual Interface dialog box is displayed. Select timeslot 1-4, click , and then click OK.
1-77

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

CAUTION
The timeslot sequence in the Selected Timeslots must map with the timeslot sequence of the remote virtual interface. 4. 5. In the operation result dialog box, click Close. Click Query, view the information of the virtual interface.

----End

1.6.12 Creating a Virtual TE Link


Without a TE link, ASON services cannot be created between a traditional NE and an ASON NE. A virtual TE link, however, uses traditional resources to realize the creation and protection for ASON services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs. You can directly create ASON services on TE links.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There must be at least two configured ASON NEs.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-27. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 is a traditional NE. In this scenario, a TE link can be created between NE3 and NE4. With the TE link, an ASON service can be rerouted to the NE3-NE5-NE4 route. Figure 1-27 Virtual TE link
NE1 NE4 Virtual TE link NE5

NE2

NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirements, you can configure the boards on NE3 and NE4 as shown in Figure 1-28, and configure the boards on NE5 as shown in Figure 1-29.
1-78 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

The 12-N1SL16 of NE3 and the 6-N1SL16 of NE5 are connected. The 12-N1SL16 of NE4 and the 13-N1SL16 of NE5 are connected. Figure 1-28 Board configuration for NE3 and NE4

Figure 1-29 Board configuration for NE5

NOTE

You need to create 16 VC4 cross-connections between 6-N1SL16 and 13-N1SL16 on NE5 in advance.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-79

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Background Information
Currently, you can create a TE link by adding a component link. On some occasions, (for example, when the J0 byte is down), the link management protocol cannot automatically discover TE links. In this case, you can create a TE link by manually creating a component link.

Procedure
l To create a TE link by directly creating a virtual TE link, perform the following operations: 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. Click Maintenance and choose Create Virtual TE Link. The Create Virtual TE Link dialog box is displayed. Enter the attributes of the TE link. For example, set the source NE to NE3 and the source port to 12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) (The optical interface must be the one connected to NE5). Set the sink NE to E4, and the sink port to 12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1) (The optical interface must be the one connected to NE5). Set the extended type to ASON Trail Creation.
NOTE

l The extended type has two options: ASON Trail Creation, Fault Detection Only or Virtual Interface. l When the TE link is used to create a service, select ASON Trail Creation. l If an MSP spans an ASON network and an SDH network over the boundary between the two networks, select Fault Detection Only. If for the second time, the fiber cut happens to a gold service, the virtual TE link is broken and triggers the rerouting. l When the rate source and sink port is different, select Virtual Interface. The TE link can be used to create a service.

5. l 1. 2. 3. 4.

Click OK. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Component Link Management from the main menu. All the component links are displayed in the list. You can view all the information about the links. Click Create. The Create Component Link dialog box is displayed. Set or enter a value for each parameter of the link and click OK.
NOTE

To create a TE link by creating a component link, perform the following operations:

After the component link is successfully created, a TE link that corresponds to the component link is automatically displayed in the SDH TE Link Management window. If the component link is deleted, the corresponding TE link automatically disappears.

----End

1.6.13 Creating a TE Link Based on Virtual Interfaces


This topic describes how to create a traffic engineering (TE) link based on virtual interfaces. When the port rates on the source and the sink are different, you can create a TE link based on virtual interfaces. Such TE links are available for creating services.
1-80 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. At least two ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
As shown in Figure 1-30, NE1 and NE4 are ASON NEs residing in ASON domain A and ASON domain B respectively. NE2 and NE3 are traditional NEs residing in a traditional synchronous digital hierarchy (SDH) network or a non-Huawei network. NE2 and NE3 are connected through a subnet, NE1 and NE2 are connected by an STM-4 fiber, and NE3 and NE4 are connected by an STM-16 fiber. It is required that ASON domain A and B be combined and managed as one ASON domain. A virtual TE link between domain A and domain B, however, cannot be directly created by using the ports of NE1 and NE4, because the link rates are different. You need to create a virtual interface of 4 Mbit/s bandwidth on NE1 and NE4. Based on the virtual interfaces, the TE link can be created successfully. Thus, the ASON domain A and B are combined as a unified ASON domain A. You can manage equipment and services within a unified ASON domain.
NOTE

If NE2 and NE3 cannot be managed by the U2000, you need to set them as virtual NEs.

Figure 1-30 TE link based on virtual interfaces

NE1 Domain A STM-4

NE2

NE3 Virtual TE Link

STM-16 Domain B NE4

: ASON NE : Traditional NE : Fiber : Trail

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-81

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Board Configuration
NE1 and NE4 are OptiX OSN 7500. Figure 1-31 shows the configuration of boards on NE1 and NE4. Figure 1-31 Board configuration for NE1 and NE4
S S S S S S S S S S S S SS S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 4 5 6 7 8
PIU

EOW GSCC GSCC

FAN

FAN

PIU AUX

S 3 3

FAN

S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
T11XCSA T11XCSA

NE2 and NE3 are abstracted as virtual NEs. Figure 1-32 shows the configuration of boards on NE2 and NE3. Figure 1-32 Board configuration for virtual NEs
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
N1SL4 N2SL16

Service Planning
Table 1-15 shows the planning of the virtual interfaces on NE1 and NE4. Table 1-15 Virtual interface planning Attribute Board Port Timeslot NE1 5-N1SL4 1 1-4 NE4 12-N2SL16 1 1-4

1-82

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

N2SL16

N1SL4

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-16 shows the planning of the virtual TE link between NE1 and NE4. Table 1-16 Virtual TE link planning Attribute Source NE Source Port Source Virtual Interface Sink NE Sink Port Sink Virtual Interface Extend Type NE1<->NE4 NE1 5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1) 1-4 NE4 12-N2SL16-1(SDH-1) 1-4 Virtual Interface

Procedure
Step 1 Disable the LMP protocol. 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer of NE1, select an NE and choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Click the ASON Protocol Management tab. Click Query to query the ASON protocol information from the NE. Select the port at which the LMP is to be disabled, e.g. 5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1). Double-click the LMP Protocol Status column and choose Disabled from the drop-down list.
NOTE

If you need to enable the LMP protocol, choose Enabled.

4. 5. 6. 7.

Click Apply. A confirmation dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. The operation result dialog box is displayed. Click Close. Click Query to query the LMP protocol status from the NE. Follow the preceding steps to disable the LMP protocol on the port 12-N2SL16-1(SDH-1) of NE4. In the NE Explorer of NE1, select a board of an ASON NE and choose ASON > ASON Link Virtual Interface Management from the Function Tree. Select the TE link whose source is NE1-5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1) and click Create Virtual Interface. The Create Virtual Interface dialog box is displayed. Select timeslot 1-4, click , and then click OK.

Step 2 Create the virtual interface. 1. 2. 3.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-83

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

CAUTION
The timeslot sequence in the Selected Timeslots must map with the timeslot sequence of the remote virtual interface. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. In the operation result dialog box, click Close. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. Click Maintenance and choose Create Virtual TE Link. The Create Virtual TE Link dialog box is displayed. Enter the attributes of the TE link. For example, set the source NE to NE1, the source port to 5-N1SL4-1(SDH-1), and the source virtual interface to 1-4. (The optical interface must be the one connected to NE2). Set the sink NE to E4, the sink port to 12-N1SL16-1(SDH-1), and the source virtual interface to 1-4. (The optical interface must be the one connected to NE3). Set the extended type to Virtual Interface. In the operation result dialog box, click Close. Click Synchronize. The virtual TE link is displayed in the link list. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Right-click the ASON domain B on the object tree and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. Select the ASON domain A from the object tree and click Synchronize NE. The NEs that reside in the ASON domain B are synchronized into the ASON domain A.

Step 3 Create the virtual TE link.

5. 6. 1. 2. 3.

Step 4 Synchronize NEs of an ASON domain from the NMS.

----End

1.6.14 Deleting an Interrupted TE Link Manually


When a TE link is interrupted, the TE link is saved on the U2000 and the link status is Interrupted. This facilitates fault locating. You can also manually delete the interrupted link.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The status of a TE link must be Interrupted.

Context
When a TE link is interrupted, the TE link is saved on the U2000 and the link status is Interrupted. You can perform a network-wide synchronization to delete all interrupted TE links, or manually delete a specific interrupted TE link. In the window for viewing alarms, you can query the interrupted TE link by viewing the TE links relevant to the alarm. Meanwhile, the interrupted TE link is displayed in the TE link management list.
1-84 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the TE link list, select one or more links whose statuses are Interrupted, right-click, and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. Step 3 In the confirmation dialog box, click OK. Step 4 A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. ----End

1.7 Managing SRGs


The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. You can find a balance point between management costs and risk control, determine the risks to be managed, and manage the risks by means of SRGs. 1.7.1 Creating an SRG The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. You can create an SRG that associates the physical topology of an ASON network to TE links. In this manner, you can easily manage risks. 1.7.2 Querying the SRG Related to a TE Link The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. SRGs and TE links are of the many-to-many relationship. That is, an SRG may contain multiple TE links and a TE link may belong to multiple SRGs. 1.7.3 Querying the SRG Related to an ASON NE You can query an SRG by means of an ASON NE.

1.7.1 Creating an SRG


The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. You can create an SRG that associates the physical topology of an ASON network to TE links. In this manner, you can easily manage risks.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. You must have the U2000 license that supports the SRG function. The TE link data exists on the U2000.

Basic Concepts
The physical topology of an ASON network in a project usually differs from the TE links in the control plane due to the differences in the planning and construction of sites, optical cables, and pipes. The two links that seem to be irrelevant on the topology may be placed in the same optical cable or pipe. Hence, the TE links in the same optical cable, pipe, and NE have the same risk. The risk refers to the probability of a link cut.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-85

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Physical Topology
Figure 1-33 shows the physical topology. NE 1 through NE 3 are ASON NEs. NE 2 and NE 3 are located on site B. Fiber 1 and fiber 3 are located in optical cable 1; fiber 2 and fiber 4 are located in optical cable 2; fiber 2 and fiber 3 are located in optical cable 3; fiber 3 and fiber 4 are located in optical cable 4; optical cable 1 and fiber 2 are located in pipe 1. Figure 1-33 Schematic diagram of the physical topology of an SRG
Node B NE2 NE3

Pipe 1 Cable 1

Fiber2

Cable 2

Cable 3 Fiber 1 Calbe 4 Fiber 3 Fiber 4 NE1 Node A : Cable : Pipe : Fiber : ASON NE

Topology of TE Links
Figure 1-34 shows the topology of TE links. Link 1 and link 3 are located between NE 1 and NE 2; link 4 is located between NE 1 and NE 3; link 2 is located between NE 2 and NE 3. All NEs are located in ASON domains. Figure 1-34 Schematic diagram of the topology of the TE links in an SRG
NE1 Link 1 Link 3 NE2

Link 4

Link 2

NE3

1-86

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Risk Analysis
The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. Table 1-17 lists the risk analysis result according to the mapping relationship between the physical topology and the TE links. Table 1-17 Risk cause analysis Risk Cause Pipe 1 is cut. Optical cable 1 is cut. Optical cable 2 is cut. Optical cable 3 is cut. Optical cable 4 is cut. A power failure occurs in NE 1. A power failure occurs in NE 2. A power failure occurs in NE 3. A power failure occurs in site B. Member Link 1, link 2, link 3 Link 1, link 3 Link 2, link 4 Link 2, link 3 Link 3, link 4 Link 1, link 3, link 4 Link 1, link 2, link 3 Link 3, link 4 Link 1, link 2, link 3, link 4

SRG Planning
A TE link can belong to multiple SRGs (you can set multiple SRG IDs) and an SRG can contain multiple TE links. Table 1-18, Table 1-19, Table 1-20, and Table 1-21 lists the division of SRGs according to the risk analysis result. Table 1-18 SRGs for pipes SRG Name SRG_pipe_001 ID 1 Member Optical cable 1, fiber 2

Table 1-19 SRGs for optical cables SRG Name SRG_cable_001 SRG_cable_002 SRG_cable_003 SRG_cable_004 ID 2 3 4 5 Member Optical cable 1 Optical cable 2 Optical cable 3 Optical cable 4

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-87

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-20 SRGs for NEs SRG Name SRG_NE_001 SRG_NE_002 SRG_NE_003 ID 6 7 8 Member NE 1 NE 2 NE 3

Table 1-21 SRGs for sites SRG Name SRG_Station_001 ID 9 Member NE 2, NE 3

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > SRG Management from the main menu. Step 2 Create an SRG for optical cables. Step 3 Click Create and the Create SRLG dialog box is displayed. Step 4 Enter the basic information about the SRG. Basic information l Name: SRG_pipe_001 l ID: 1 l ASON Domain: ASON l Type: pipe l Remarks: pipe Step 5 Add optical cable 1 to the SRG. 1. 2. . The object whose name In the Name text box, enter Optical cable and click begins with Optical cable is filtered out and displayed in the dialog box. Select Optical Cable 1 and click > to add it to the Selected Object pane.
NOTE

If the queried information is null, there is no information in the Unselected Object field.

Step 6 Add fiber 1 to the SRG. 1. 2. In the Name text box, enter Fiber and click . The object whose name begins with Fiber is filtered out and displayed in the dialog box. Select Fiber 1 and click > to add it to the Selected Object pane.
NOTE

If the queried information is null, there is no information in the Unselected Object field.

1-88

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 7 Click OK. Step 8 Repeat Steps 1 through 7 to create other SRGs according to the SRG planning. ----End

1.7.2 Querying the SRG Related to a TE Link


The TE links in the same optical cable, NE, site, and pipe have the same risk. SRGs and TE links are of the many-to-many relationship. That is, an SRG may contain multiple TE links and a TE link may belong to multiple SRGs.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. You must have the U2000 license that supports the SRG function. The TE link data exists on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select one or more TE links, right-click, and then choose Query Relevant SRGs from the shortcut menu. Step 3 The SRG Management window is displayed showing the SRG related to the selected TE link.
NOTE

No SRG is displayed if there is no SRG related to the TE link.

----End

1.7.3 Querying the SRG Related to an ASON NE


You can query an SRG by means of an ASON NE.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. You must have the U2000 license that supports the SRG function. An SRG must be created on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the Object Tree, select the ASON domain where the NE to be queried resides and click the ASON NE tab. Step 3 Select one or more NEs, right-click, and then choose Query Relevant SRGs from the shortcut menu. Step 4 The SRG Management window is displayed showing the SRG related to the selected NE. ----End
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-89

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.8 Creating ASON Services


The trail levels that an ASON trail supports are as follows: diamond, gold, silver, copper and iron. The trail levels that an ASON server trail supports are as follows: gold, silver and copper. A label switched path (LSP) is a trail passed through by an ASON service. It is also called an ASON trail.

Background Information
The U2000 provides the end-to-end ASON trail management feature and supports services at five classes of service (CoS) as follows: l l l l l Diamond service: provides 1+1 protection (for example, SNCP) and rerouting ability. Gold service: provides 1:1 protection (for example, MSP) and rerouting ability. Silver service: provides rerouting services and re-calculates a route in the real time. Copper service: does not provide protection in the case of a fault. Iron service: extra services which can be preempted and have no protection.
NOTE

OptiX OSN 3800 and OptiX OSN 6800 support the WDM ASON client trail.

1.8.1 Synchronizing ASON Trails By synchronizing the ASON trails, the ASON trail data on the U2000 is kept consistent with that in the ASON network. 1.8.2 Creating a Diamond ASON Service You can create an ASON trail with the diamond-class protection. 1.8.3 Creating a Gold ASON service You can create an ASON trail with the gold-class protection. When you create a gold service, primarily use the working TE links. If the working TE links are insufficient, you can use the unprotected TE link resources. It is recommended that you ensure that sufficient working resources are available in the network before you create a gold service. 1.8.4 Creating a Silver ASON Service You can create an ASON trail with the silver-class protection. If a silver ASON trail fails, the rerouting is periodically initiated until the trail is successfully rerouted. If the network resource is insufficient, the service may be interrupted. Since the system calculates the reverting trail for a silver trail in real time, you do not need to reserve resources for it. In this sense, the silver services have a high bandwidth utilization. 1.8.5 Creating a Copper ASON Service You can create an ASON trail with the copper-class protection. Copper services are not used often. Usually they are used to configure temporary services. 1.8.6 Creating an Iron ASON Service You can create an ASON trail with the iron-class protection. When you create an iron service, primarily use the protection resource of a TE link. If the protection resource is insufficient, you can use the non-protection resource of the TE link. It is recommended that you ensure sufficient protection resources in the network before creating an iron service. 1.8.7 Creating an ASON Server Trail
1-90 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

An ASON server trail is mainly used to carry lower order services (VC3 or VC12). An ASON server trail is applicable to diamond, gold, silver, or copper services. At the NE side, an ASON server trail is also called a tunnel service. 1.8.8 Creating a Segmented ASON Server Trail In the case of a end-to-end tunnel that traverses multiple nodes, the intermediate nodes cannot add or drop lower order services through this UNI link. In this case, you can use the sectioned tunnel to ensure that multiple nodes share the tunnel bandwidth. 1.8.9 Creating Two Associated SDH ASON Trails The ASON trail association function associates two services so that the two services are not preempted by each other during the rerouting and optimization. 1.8.10 Setting ASON Trail Association ASON trail association means two ASON trails are associated. The associated trails are separated from each other during the service optimization and rerouting whenever possible. Service association is applied to access services that have two access points. After two trails are associated, if one of the trails (or server trails) is rerouted or optimized, the ASON NE adopts the 1+1 routing policy to try to avoid the associated ASON trail (or server trail). 1.8.11 Creating ASON Services in Batches The batch creation function is always used if a large number of ASON services need to be created. 1.8.12 Deactivating the SDH ASON Trail Deactivating an SDH ASON trail can release the resources that the trail occupies. 1.8.13 Deleting an ASON Trail The operation of deleting ASON trails removes the trail data from the U2000 and the NE.

1.8.1 Synchronizing ASON Trails


By synchronizing the ASON trails, the ASON trail data on the U2000 is kept consistent with that in the ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON trail must be created on the U2000.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Optional: Set the filter criteria in the Filter dialog box, and select methods as needed. In the Prompt dialog box displayed, click Yes. l If you need to filter all the trails, click Filter All. l If you need to add more trails that match the requirement to the list, click Incremental Filter. l If you need to filter the trails in the list, click Secondary Filter. Step 3 Click Synchronize, in the Synchronize dialog box displayed, set the Domain and Attributes.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-91

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Attributes: basic information, working state, SLA-compliant, rerouting attributes and associated services. l You can also select one or more ASON trails, right-click and choose Synchronize from the shortcut menu to synchronize the selected ASON trails. At this time, the synchronized attributes for the ASON trails are consistent with the synchronization attributes that you set in the Synchronize window.

Step 4 Click Synchronize. Step 5 In the Browse New/Lost Service on NE dialog box, view the new services and lost services of the NE. Step 6 Click Close. ----End

1.8.2 Creating a Diamond ASON Service


You can create an ASON trail with the diamond-class protection.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized networkwide TE links and have sufficient TE link resources.

Background Information
When you create a diamond service, you need to properly configure the rerouting attributes as required. The following descriptions are based on the permanent 1+1 diamond service.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-35. A permanent 1+1 diamond service at the rate of 155 Mbit/s is required between NE1 and NE3. The working LSP is required to pass NE2 and the protection LSP is required to pass NE4. Figure 1-35 Diamond service requirement
NE1

Working LSP

Protection LSP
NE4

NE2

NE3

: ASON NE : LSP

1-92

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-36. Figure 1-36 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-22 to plan the diamond service. Table 1-22 Diamond service planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class SNCP Access NE1<->NE3 NE1 13-SLQ1-1 1 NE3 13-SLQ1-1 1 Diamond None

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-93

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Route constraint

NE1<->NE3 Working path: NE1-NE2NE3; protection path: NE1NE4-NE3 Revertive Mode Lockout Priority Trigger condition CrankBack Policy Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error Rerouting Hold-off time Non-Revertive Unlocked 1 Reroute when one trail fails 1 Use existing trails whenever possible No 0

Rerouting attributes

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, enter the trail information as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0001 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Diamond l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation l OVPN Customer: Share Resource Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, enter the attributes as follows: l Revetrive Mode: Non-Revetrive l Lockout: Unlocked l Priority: 1 l Trigger Condition: Reroute when one trail fails l CrankBack: 1 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error: No l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK.
1-94 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

For example, select the SLQ1 in slot 13, the port 1 and the timeslot 1. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Optional: Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, you can do as follows: l Select the Working option button. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. l Select the Protection option button. Right-click NE4 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 9 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 10 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-95

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 11 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 12 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 13 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.3 Creating a Gold ASON service


You can create an ASON trail with the gold-class protection. When you create a gold service, primarily use the working TE links. If the working TE links are insufficient, you can use the unprotected TE link resources. It is recommended that you ensure that sufficient working resources are available in the network before you create a gold service.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources. All links that the ASON trail passes through are under MSP protection. Otherwise, you need to create fibers and configure the MSP protection before creating 1:1, 1:N, or 1+1 protected ASON trails.

The U2000 supports displaying the valid route of a gold service after multiplex section (MS) switching. The requirements of realizing the function are as follows: l l l l The license for end-to-end must be available. The gold service must be managed in the end-to-end mode. The MS protection (MSP) ring on which the gold service runs must be searched out. When you query the valid route on the U2000 after the MS switching of a gold service occurs, if the network interface fails to return the route data, the returned data is null, or the returned route segment does not contain the information of source and sink NEs of ASON route segment, the query of valid route fails. In this case, the actual route of the ASON module is displayed.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-37. Four ASON NEs compose an MSP ring. A gold service at the rate of 155 Mbit/ s is required between NE1 and NE3.
1-96 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-37 Gold service requirement


NE1

NE 2

MSP Ring

NE4

NE3

: ASON NE

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards on the NEs as shown in Figure 1-38. Figure 1-38 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-23 to plan a gold service. Table 1-23 Gold service planning Attribute Source NE
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NE1<->NE3 NE1
1-97

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class Route constraint SNCP Access Rerouting attribute Revertive Mode Lockout Priority CrankBack Policy Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error Rerouting Hold-off time

NE1<->NE3 13-SLQ1-2 1 NE3 13-SLQ1-2 1 gold The service route must pass NE2. None Non-revertive Unlocked 2 1 Use existing trails whenever possible No 0

Background Information
The procedure for creating a gold ASON trail is similar to that described in "Creating a Diamond ASON Trail". The difference lies in that the protection type is Gold.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0002 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Gold l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation l OVPN Customer: Share Resource
1-98 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Revetrive Mode: Non-Revetrive l Lockout: Unlocked l Priority: 2 l CrankBack: 1 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error: No l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the SLQ1 in slot 13, the port 2 and the timeslot 1. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Optional: Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, select Working. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 9 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-99

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 10 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.
NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 11 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 12 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 13 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.4 Creating a Silver ASON Service


You can create an ASON trail with the silver-class protection. If a silver ASON trail fails, the rerouting is periodically initiated until the trail is successfully rerouted. If the network resource is insufficient, the service may be interrupted. Since the system calculates the reverting trail for a silver trail in real time, you do not need to reserve resources for it. In this sense, the silver services have a high bandwidth utilization.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-39. The four NEs are all ASON NEs. A silver service at the rate of 155 Mbit/s is required between NE1 and NE3.

1-100

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-39 Silver service requirement


NE1

NE2

NE4

NE3

ASON NE LSP

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards on the NEs as shown in Figure 1-40. Figure 1-40 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-24 to plan a silver service. Table 1-24 Silver service planning Attribute Source NE
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NE1<->NE3 NE1
1-101

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class SNCP Access Route constraint Rerouting attribute Revertive Mode Lockout Priority CrankBack Policy Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error Rerouting Hold-off time

NE1<->NE3 13-SLQ1-3 1 NE3 13-SLQ1-3 1 Silver None The service route must pass NE2. Automatically Revertive Unlocked 2 1 Use existing trails whenever possible No 0

Background Information
The procedure for creating a silver ASON trail is similar to that described in "Creating a Diamond ASON Trail". The difference lies in that the protection type is Silver.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0003 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Silver l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation l OVPN Customer: Share Resource
1-102 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Revetrive Mode: Automatically Revetrive l WTR Time(s): 600 l Lockout: Unlocked l Priority: 2 l CrankBack: 1 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the SLQ1 in slot 13, the port 3 and the timeslot 1. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Optional: Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, select Working. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 9 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-103

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 10 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.
NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 11 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 12 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 13 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.5 Creating a Copper ASON Service


You can create an ASON trail with the copper-class protection. Copper services are not used often. Usually they are used to configure temporary services.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-41. The four NEs are all ASON NEs. A copper service at the rate of 155 Mbit/s is required between NE1 and NE3. Figure 1-41 Copper service requirement
NE1

NE2

NE4

NE3

ASON NE LSP

1-104

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-42. Figure 1-42 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-25 to plan a copper service. Table 1-25 Copper service planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class Route constraint NE1<->NE3 NE1 13-SLQ1-4 1 NE3 13-SLQ1-4 1 Copper The service route must pass NE2.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-105

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Background Information
The procedure for creating a copper ASON trail is similar to that described in "Creating a Diamond ASON Trail". The difference lies in that the protection type is Copper.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0004 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Copper l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation Step 4 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the SLQ1 in slot 13, the port 4, and the timeslot 1. Step 5 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 6 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 7 Optional: Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, select the Working option button. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 8 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.
1-106 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

NOTE

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 9 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.
NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 10 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 11 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 12 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.6 Creating an Iron ASON Service


You can create an ASON trail with the iron-class protection. When you create an iron service, primarily use the protection resource of a TE link. If the protection resource is insufficient, you can use the non-protection resource of the TE link. It is recommended that you ensure sufficient protection resources in the network before creating an iron service.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources. All links that the ASON trail passes through are under MSP protection. Otherwise, you need to create fibers and configure the MSP protection before creating 1:1, 1:N, or 1+1 protected ASON trails.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-43. The four ASON NEs compose an MSP ring. An iron service at the rate of 155 Mbit/s is required between NE1 and NE3.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-107

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-43 Iron service requirement


NE1

NE 2

MSP Ring

NE4

NE3

: ASON NE

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-44. Figure 1-44 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-26 to plan an iron service. Table 1-26 Iron service planning Attribute Source NE
1-108 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NE1<->NE3 NE1
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class Route constraint

NE1<->NE3 6-SLQ1-1 1 NE3 6-SLQ1-1 1 Iron The service route must pass NE2.

Background Information
The procedure for creating an iron ASON trail is similar to that described in "Creating a Diamond ASON Trail". The difference lies in that the protection type is Iron.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0005 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Iron l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation Step 4 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the SLQ1 in slot 6, the port 1 and the timeslot 1. Step 5 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 6 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 7 Optional: Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-109

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, select the Working option button. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 8 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 9 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.
NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 10 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 11 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 12 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End
1-110 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.8.7 Creating an ASON Server Trail


An ASON server trail is mainly used to carry lower order services (VC3 or VC12). An ASON server trail is applicable to diamond, gold, silver, or copper services. At the NE side, an ASON server trail is also called a tunnel service.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources.

Service Requirement
The following descriptions are based on a diamond ASON server trail. See Figure 1-45. Eight VC12 services need to be transmitted between NE1 and NE3, and the diamond-class protection is required for these trails. In this case, you need to configure ASON server trails. Figure 1-45 Diamond ASON server trail requirement
NE1 VC12

NE2

Working

Protection

NE4

Diamond tunnel NE3

Diamond tunnel VC12 : ASON NE

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-46.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-111

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-46 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-27 to plan a diamond ASON server trail. Table 1-27 Diamond ASON server trail planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class ASON server trail SNCP Access Route constraint NE1<->NE3 NE1 2-PQ1 1-8 NE3 2-PQ1 1-8 Diamond Diamond ASON server trail None Working path: NE1-NE2NE3; protection path: NE1NE4-NE3 Revertive Mode Non-revertive
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Rerouting attributes
1-112

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Lockout Priority Rerouting trigger condition CrankBack Rerouting policy Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error Rerouting Hold-off time

NE1<->NE3 Unlocked 1 Reroute when one trail fails 1 Use existing trails whenever possible No 0

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0009 l Type: ASON Server Trail l Class: Diamond l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Revertive: Non-Revertive. (For revertive ASON server trails, select Revertive, For scheduled revertive ASON server trails, select Scheduled revertive.) l Lockout: Unlocked l Priority: 1 l Trigger Condition: Reroute when one trail fails l CrankBack: 1 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error: No l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 Step 5 On the left-hand side of the window, click Browse beside Source. In the dialog box displayed, select the desired NE, slot, port, or timeslot. Click OK. Step 6 On the left-hand side of the window, click Browse beside Sink. In the dialog box displayed, select the desired NE, slot, port, or timeslot. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-113

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, you can do as follows: l Select the Working option button. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. l Select the Protection option button. Right-click NE4 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 9 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 10 Optional: Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.
NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 11 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.

1-114

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management
NOTE

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 12 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 13 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.8 Creating a Segmented ASON Server Trail


In the case of a end-to-end tunnel that traverses multiple nodes, the intermediate nodes cannot add or drop lower order services through this UNI link. In this case, you can use the sectioned tunnel to ensure that multiple nodes share the tunnel bandwidth.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized the links of the entire network and have sufficient link resources.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-47. There are ASON server trails available between NE1 and NE2, and between NE2 and NE3. To improve the resource utilization, you do not need to create an additional server trail between NE1 and NE3 to create a lower order services between NE1 and NE3, but directly create the service based on the two segments of existing server trails. This server trail between NE1 and NE3, which consists of two segments in this case, is called a segmented server trail. Figure 1-47 Segmented ASON server trail requirement
NE4

NE1

NE3 lower order service from NE1 to NE3 Silver tunnel lower order service from NE1 to NE2

NE2 Silver tunnel

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-48.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-115

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-48 Board configuration for NE1-NE3

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-28 to plan a segmented ASON server trail between NE1 and NE3. Table 1-28 Silver ASON server trail planning Attribute Source NE Sink NE Protection class Route constraint NE1<->NE2 NE1 NE2 Silver ASON server trail Routes are automatically calculated. NE2<->NE3 NE2 NE3

NOTE

The boards and timeslots occupied by an ASON server trail can be queried in the ASON Trail Management window after the server trail is created. The following description is based on the assumption that on NE1, the first VC4 of 11-N2SL64-1 is occupied; on NE2, the first VC4 of 11-N2SL64-1 and the first VC4 of 8-N2SL64-1 are occupied; on NE3, the first VC4 of 8-N2SL64-1 is occupied.

Table 1-29 shows the VC12 service planning on NE1, NE2 and NE3.

1-116

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-29 VC12 service planning on NE1, NE2 and NE Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction Cross-Connection on NE1 2- PQ1 1 11-N2SL64-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional Cross-Connection on NE2 8-N2SL64-1 1 1 11-N2SL64-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional Cross-Connection on NE3 8-N2SL64-1 1 1 2- PQ1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail to create a VC4 server trail. Step 3 Enter the information about the VC4 server trail. For example, set the server trail as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 Server Trail l Source: NE1 l Sink: NE2 Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab. Step 5 Set the protection type to Silver. Step 6 Check the Activate the Trail check box. Click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close.
NOTE

If you check the Activate the Trail check box, the created trail is applied to the so that the trail is in the activated state.

Step 7 Repeat Steps 1 through 6 to create a VC4 server trail between NE2 and NE3. Step 8 In the Create Trail window, enter the information about the VC12 trail. For example, set the VC12 trail as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC12 l Source: NE1-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1)
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-117

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Sink: NE3-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) Step 9 Check the Activate the Trail check box. Click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 10 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next repeatedly until the Finish button is displayed. Click Finish. Step 11 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details about the VC4 server trail and the VC12 trail that you create. Step 12 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. View the information about the created ASON trail. ----End

1.8.9 Creating Two Associated SDH ASON Trails


The ASON trail association function associates two services so that the two services are not preempted by each other during the rerouting and optimization.

Prerequisite
l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Application Scenario
As shown in Figure 1-49, the 1+1 services need to be created between R1 and R2 and pass through the ASON network. To ensure that the two trails do not pass through the same ASON node, the two ASON trails must be associated. After the two ASON trails are associated, one ASON trail will not be rerouted to the other ASON trail. Figure 1-49 Two associated ASON trails

R1

I F

A C B

H G

R2

: ASON NE : User Equipment

1-118

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Background Information
NOTE

Currently, association is supported between silver trails, between copper trails, between silver and copper trails, between silver server trails, between copper server trails, and between silver and copper server trails.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the SDH ASON Trail Management window, choose Create > Association Trail. Step 3 In the SDH ASON Association Trail Creation window, enter Basic Information and Route Restriction of trail 1 and trail 2. The example is provided as follows:

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-119

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks


NOTE

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Only the association between routes in silver or copper protection is supported. Hence, set the protection type of trail 1 and trail 2 to silver or copper. The default protection type is silver. l In the view on the right, right-click an NE and set route constraints such as explicit node and excluded node. l In the case of the SDH ASON NE of the GCP V100R007C02 version or a later version, and the OptiX OSN 9560 NE of the GSP V100R004 version or later version, you can create the associated ASON trails that share the same source or that have different sources. l In the case of the SDH ASON NE of the GCP V100R007C01 version or a later version, and the OptiX OSN 9560 NE of the GSP V100R002 version or later version, you can create the associated ASON trails that share the same source.

Step 4 Set the common attributes, including the Revertive Mode, WTR Time, Lockout, Priority, CrackBack, Trigger Condition for Rerouting Associated Route, Policy, Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error and Rerouting Hold-off time.

Step 5 Select Automatic Pre-Calculation or click Pre-Calculate. After the operation is successful, close the operation result dialog box.
NOTE

l In the case of the SDH ASON NE of the GCP V100R007C02 version or a later version, and the OptiX OSN 9560 NE of the GSP V100R004 version or later version, you can pre-calculate the associated ASON trails that share the same source or that have different sources. l Only after you pre-calculated successfully the associated ASON trails that have different sources, you could create them.

Step 6 Click Apply. After confirmation, apply the configuration. Step 7 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.10 Setting ASON Trail Association


ASON trail association means two ASON trails are associated. The associated trails are separated from each other during the service optimization and rerouting whenever possible. Service association is applied to access services that have two access points. After two trails are associated, if one of the trails (or server trails) is rerouted or optimized, the ASON NE adopts the 1+1 routing policy to try to avoid the associated ASON trail (or server trail).

Prerequisite
l l
1-120

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There must be at least two configured ASON NEs.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Background Information
l Currently, association is supported between silver trails, between copper trails, between silver and copper trails, between silver server trails, between copper server trails, and between silver and copper server trails. The system supports automatically setting association only for SNCP ASON-SDH trails in a single domain. For SNCP ASON-SDH trails in multiple domains, you need to manually set association. Associating the two trails may clear their preset restoration trails.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the SDH ASON Trail Management list, select two ASON trails to be associated. Right-click them and choose Set Association. Step 3 In the confirm dialog box, click Yes. A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation was successful. Step 4 Click Close. Step 5 Optional: Select an ASON trail in the SDH ASON Trail Management list. Right-click and choose Set Association Source from the shortcut menu. Select another ASON trail, right-click and choose Set Association from the shortcut menu. In the confirm dialog box, click Yes. A dialog box appears, telling that the trails are successfully associated. Click Close.
NOTE

To cancel the association relations, right-click and choose Remove Association. A dialog box is displayed indicating that this operation may decrease the service protection ability.

Step 6 The dialog box is displayed, set the associated route attributes, including trigger condition for rerouting associated route, click OK. Step 7 A dialog box appears, telling that the operation succeeded. Click Close. Step 8 Select a trail in the SDH ASON Trail Management list. You can know whether the association is successful by viewing the value of Associated or Not. Step 9 Optional: In the lower left area of the SDH ASON Trail Management window, click the Associated Route tab to view the information about the two associated trails. ----End

1.8.11 Creating ASON Services in Batches


The batch creation function is always used if a large number of ASON services need to be created.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The U2000 must have synchronized networkwide TE links and have sufficient TE link resources.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-121

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-50. The four NEs are all ASON NEs. Three non-revertive silver services at the rate of 155 Mbit/s are required to be configured between NE1 and NE3. Figure 1-50 Batch silver service requirement
NE1

NE2

NE4

NE3

ASON NE LSP

Board Configuration
To meet the previously mentioned service requirement, you can configure the boards as shown in Figure 1-51. Figure 1-51 Board configuration for NE1 and NE3
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N1SL16 N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Service Planning
To meet the service requirement, you can refer to Table 1-30 to plan a silver service.
1-122 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

GSCC GSCC

AUX

PIU

PIU

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-30 Silver service planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class Route constraint Rerouting attribute Reversion mode Lockout Priority CrankBack Policy Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error Rerouting Holdoff time NE1<->NE3 NE1 6-N1SL16-1 6 NE3 13-N1SL16-1 6 Silver The service route must pass NE2. Non-revertive Unlocked 2 1 Use the existing trail whenever possible No 13-N1SL16-1 7 13-N1SL16-1 8 6-N1SL16-1 7 6-N1SL16-1 8

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, set the attributes as follows: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0006 l Type: ASON Server l Class: Silver l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation l OVPN Customer: Share Resource Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, set the attributes as follows:

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-123

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Revetrive Mode: Non-Revetrive (Select Automatically Revertive or Scheduled Revertive if the silver service is revertive.) l Lockout: Unlocked l Priority: 2 l CrankBack: 1 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error: No l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select port 1 and timeslot 6 of the N1SL16. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Set Explicit Node or Explicit Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

NOTE

l If you want to specify the timeslot when setting the explicit link, choose Browse from the shortcut menu. l After you select the Set Explicit Link shortcut menu item, its submenu is displayed in a folded manner if there are more than ten available explicit links. l To cancel the Explicit Node or Explicit Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Explicit Node or Cancel Explicit Link.

For example, select the Working option button. Right-click NE2 in the right-hand topology and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. Step 9 Optional: Set Excluded Node or Excluded Link. Right-click an NE in the right-hand topology and select an option from the shortcut menu as needed.

1-124

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management
NOTE

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

If you need to cancel the Excluded Node or Excluded Link, right-click an NE and choose Cancel Excluded Node or Cancel Excluded Link from the shortcut menu.

Step 10 Set the Activate or Duplicate after created check box.


NOTE

l If you check the Activate check box, a created trail is applied to the NE so that the trail is in the activated state. l If you check the Duplicate after created check box, after a trail is created, you can create multiple trails that share the same source and sink by duplicating the created trail.

Step 11 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 12 Click Close. In the Copy dialog box displayed, select the source and sink timeslots. Click Add. For example, select the timeslots 7-8 of the source NE (NE1-6-N1SL16-1(SDH-1)-VC4-7-8) and the timeslots 7-8 of the sink NE (NE3-13-N1SL16-1(SDH-1)-VC4-7-8). Step 13 Check the Activate after Duplicate and Duplicate Route Constraint check boxes. Step 14 Confirm that the trail and route information is correctly entered. Click OK. Step 15 After the creation is complete, a dialog box appears, telling that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 16 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.8.12 Deactivating the SDH ASON Trail


Deactivating an SDH ASON trail can release the resources that the trail occupies.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information
NOTE

You do not need to cancel the association configured before deactivating the associated ASON trail, because the system automatically cancels the association during the deactivation operation. During the SDH ASON trail management, if an active client trail exists, the corresponding ASON server trail cannot be deactivated.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-125

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 2 In the list, select the ASON trail to be deactivated. Right-click and choose Deactivate.
NOTE

After you deactivate trails in batches, wait for several minutes (not less than five minutes) before you perform other operations. It is recommended not to deactivate trails in batches.

Step 3 Click Yes in the confirmation dialog box displayed twice.


NOTE

If the selected trails contain the trails that are managed by SDH trails, the confirmation dialog box is displayed for the third time. Click Yes. The Operation Result dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation fails. You can click Detail to view failure causes. If the trails to be deactivated contain associated trails, the NMS cancels the trail association before deactivating them. Detailed situations are as follows: l If the trail association fails to be canceled, the NMS stops the deactivation and reports the failure of canceling the association. l If the trail association is canceled successfully but the deactivation fails, the NMS reports the deactivation failure and the successful association cancelation. l If the trail association is canceled and the trails are deactivated successfully, the NMS reports that the deactivation is successful. l If a trail is deactivated successfully but the associated trail fails to be deactivated, the NMS reports that the operation is partially successful and the association is canceled for the trail failing to be deactivated.

Step 4 After the operation is complete, the system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. The list shows that the ASON trail is in the Inactive state. ----End

1.8.13 Deleting an ASON Trail


The operation of deleting ASON trails removes the trail data from the U2000 and the NE.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON service must be inactive.

Background Information
NOTE

l Deleting an ASON trail removes the trail data from the U2000 and the NE. Exercise caution when you perform this operation. l In the SDH ASON Trail Management, if an active client trail exists, the corresponding ASON server trail cannot be deactivated. l When deactivating associated ASON services, do not delete the association first. The system automatically deletes the association during deactivation.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select a deactivated ASON trail from the list, right-click, and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. Step 3 Click OK in the confirmation dialog box.
1-126 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 4 After the deletion is complete, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation was successful. Click Close. ----End

1.9 Modifying the Attributes of ASON Services


As an ASON network is changing, you need to modify the attributes of ASON services in the network according to different ASON features. This facilitates the configuration, management and maintenance of the ASON network. 1.9.1 Viewing ASON Service Attributes You can view the detailed information of an ASON trail, including the basic attributes, constraint routes, shared MESH restoration trail status information, associated ASON trail attributes, and SLA-compliant. 1.9.2 Setting the Routing Attributes You can set the routing attributes for an ASON service, including rerouting revertive mode, WTR time, scheduled revertive time, rerouting lockout status, revertive lockout, rerouting triggered by B3 bit error, rerouting priority, trigger condition, times of crankbacks and route selection policy. 1.9.3 Setting the Scheduled Reversion Time If the ASON service is rerouted successfully, you can set the scheduled reversion time after the original trail is restored. Before the scheduled reversion time expires, the service is automatically returned to the original trail. If you set the scheduled reversion time when the fault in the original path is not rectified, the service may be interrupted. 1.9.4 Setting the B3 Alarm to Trigger Rerouting After the diamond service, gold service, or silver service is created, you can set the B3 alarm as a condition for triggering rerouting. 1.9.5 Setting Preset Restoration Trail You can set priorities for rerouting ASON trails. When an ASON service is being rerouted, the service has the priority to be restored to the preset trail. If the preset restoration trail is occupied, the system computes the route again. 1.9.6 Setting Shared MESH Restoration Trail You can preset a shared MESH restoration trail for an ASON trail. When an ASON service is rerouted, you can restore the service to the preset trail with priority. The control plane reserves the timeslot used by the shared MESH restoration trail. That is, the timeslot cannot be used by other services during the service creation or rerouting. 1.9.7 Setting the Original Route The route of an ASON service is usually the original route when the service is created. If the route of an ASON service changes, you can also set the route after change to the original route.

1.9.1 Viewing ASON Service Attributes


You can view the detailed information of an ASON trail, including the basic attributes, constraint routes, shared MESH restoration trail status information, associated ASON trail attributes, and SLA-compliant.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-127

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. An ASON trail must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the trail list, right-click the ASON trail that you want to view and choose Details from the shortcut menu. Step 3 In the dialog box displayed, view the basic attributes of the ASON trail.

Step 4 Click the Restrictive Route tab. View the route constraint information of the ASON trail. Step 5 Optional: If an associated trail is set for the ASON trail, click the Associated ASON Trail Attribute tab to view the attributes of the associated trail. Step 6 Click the SLA-Compliant Details tab to view the details of the SLA-compliant of the ASON trail. Step 7 Optional: If a shared MESH restoration trail is set, click the Shared MESH Restoration Trail Status Details tab to view the details of the shared MESH restoration trail status. ----End
1-128 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.9.2 Setting the Routing Attributes


You can set the routing attributes for an ASON service, including rerouting revertive mode, WTR time, scheduled revertive time, rerouting lockout status, revertive lockout, rerouting triggered by B3 bit error, rerouting priority, trigger condition, times of crankbacks and route selection policy.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be configured and the NE data must be uploaded.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails, right-click and choose Set Routing Attributes from the shortcut menu. The Set Routing Attributes dialog box is displayed.

NOTE

When you create an ASON trail, you can set the rerouting attributes. Click Create > ASON Trail. In the ASON Trail Management user interface, click Routing Attributes tab to set the rerouting attributes.

Step 3 In the Set Routing Attributes user interface, set attributes of routing and click OK.
NOTE

l Currently, you can set trigger conditions of routing for diamond services only. l Revertive Mode includes Non-Revertive, Scheduled Revertive, and Scheduled Revertive. If the Revertive Mode is set as Scheduled Revertive, you need to set Scheduled revertive time.

Step 4 In the confirmation dialog box displayed, click Yes. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation was successful. Click Close. ----End

1.9.3 Setting the Scheduled Reversion Time


If the ASON service is rerouted successfully, you can set the scheduled reversion time after the original trail is restored. Before the scheduled reversion time expires, the service is automatically returned to the original trail. If you set the scheduled reversion time when the fault in the original path is not rectified, the service may be interrupted.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-129

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
l l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON service must be rerouted successfully. Revertive Mode of the ASON service must be set to Scheduled revertive. The NE time must be synchronous with the NM time.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails, right-click and choose Set Routing Attributes from the shortcut menu. The Set Routing Attributes dialog box is displayed.

NOTE

When you create an ASON trail, you can set the rerouting attributes. Click Create > ASON Trail. In the ASON Trail Management user interface, click Routing Attributes tab to set the rerouting attributes.

Step 3 Click Revertive Mode and choose Scheduled Revertive from the drop-down list. Step 4 In Set Routing Attributes, select the Scheduled revertive time check box and set the time limit within which the service must be returned to the original trail after the original trail is restored. Step 5 Set the other items according to the actual planning information. Then, click OK. Step 6 Then, another dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. ----End

1.9.4 Setting the B3 Alarm to Trigger Rerouting


After the diamond service, gold service, or silver service is created, you can set the B3 alarm as a condition for triggering rerouting.

Prerequisite
l l
1-130

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The data of the ASON NEs must be configured and uploaded.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

The NE time must be synchronous with the NM time.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails, right-click and choose Set Routing Attributes from the shortcut menu. The Set Routing Attributes dialog box is displayed.

NOTE

When you create an ASON trail, you can set the rerouting attributes. Click Create > ASON Trail. In the ASON Trail Management user interface, click Routing Attributes tab to set the rerouting attributes.

Step 3 In Set Routing Attributes, set Rerouting Triggered by B3 Bit Error to Yes.
NOTE

The B3_EXC and B3_SD alarms can trigger the rerouting.

Step 4 Set the other items according to the actual planning information. Then, click OK. Step 5 Then, another dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. ----End

1.9.5 Setting Preset Restoration Trail


You can set priorities for rerouting ASON trails. When an ASON service is being rerouted, the service has the priority to be restored to the preset trail. If the preset restoration trail is occupied, the system computes the route again.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The rerouting ASON trail must be created. The U2000 must have synchronized networkwide TE links and have sufficient TE link resources.

Background Information
Currently, the diamond, gold, and silver ASON trails and the silver ASON server trails support setting the restoration reverting trail.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-131

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

In the case of the ASON NEs of the GCP V100R007C02 version or a later version, a preset restoration trail is rerouted when if a link of the preset restoration trail is interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select an ASON service and click Maintenance. Choose Set Preset Restoration Trail from the drop-down menu. Step 3 Click Pre-Calculation Route to view the related information. Click Apply to complete the settings of the preset reverting trail.
NOTE

If the Automatic Pre-Calculation check box is checked, the U2000 sends a command to ask the NE to automatically precalculate the route. Any change to the route constraints triggers the automatic precalculation.

Step 4 Optional: On the topology, right-click an NE and set the route constraints. Click the Route Restriction to view or set the information of Explicit Node, Excluded Node, Explicit Link and Excluded Link. Click Apply to complete the settings of the preset restoration trail. ----End

1.9.6 Setting Shared MESH Restoration Trail


You can preset a shared MESH restoration trail for an ASON trail. When an ASON service is rerouted, you can restore the service to the preset trail with priority. The control plane reserves the timeslot used by the shared MESH restoration trail. That is, the timeslot cannot be used by other services during the service creation or rerouting.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There must be at least two configured ASON NEs.

Background Information
l l l Currently, only the revertive silver ASON trails and the silver ASON server trails support setting the shared MESH restoration trail. If a timeslot is configured with a multiplex section, the timeslot is grayed out and cannot be selected. Multiple revertive silver services can share the same shared MESH restoration trail.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select one revertive silver ASON service and click Maintenance. Select Set Shared MESH Restoration Trail from the drop-down list. Step 3 Click Pre-Calculation Route to view the related information. Click Apply to complete the settings of the shared MESH restoration trail.
1-132 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management
NOTE

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

If the Automatic Pre-Calculation check box is checked, the U2000 sends a command to ask the NE to automatically precalculate the route. Any change to the route constraints triggers the automatic precalculation.

Step 4 Optional: On the topology, right-click an NE and set the route constraints. Click the Route Restriction to view the information of Explicit Node and Excluded Node. Click Apply to complete the settings of the shared MESH restoration trail. ----End

1.9.7 Setting the Original Route


The route of an ASON service is usually the original route when the service is created. If the route of an ASON service changes, you can also set the route after change to the original route.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There must be at least two configured ASON NEs.

Background Information
For a non-revertive trail, if the original route is normally restored after trail rerouting, the trail cannot automatically revert to the original route. For a revertive ASON service, if the failure is cleared after rerouting, the service automatically reverts.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Set a trail that you want to set and click Maintenance. Choose Save As Original Route from the drop-down menu. Step 3 In the confirmation dialog box displayed, click Yes. Step 4 A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation was successful. Click Close to complete the setting of the original route. Step 5 Optional: Set a trail for which the original route is already set and click Maintenance. Choose Refresh Original Route from the drop-down menu. ----End

1.10 Modifying the Route of an ASON Service


As an ASON network is changing, you need to modify the route of an ASON service in the network according to different situations. This facilitates the configuration, management and maintenance of the ASON network. 1.10.1 Reverting ASON Trails After rerouting, you can revert an ASON trail to the original route or the route before rerouting, based on the reverting function supported by the ASON. 1.10.2 Optimizing an ASON Service
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-133

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

To manually adjust one or more service trails, you can use the optimization function to transfer the ASON service to the expected trails.

1.10.1 Reverting ASON Trails


After rerouting, you can revert an ASON trail to the original route or the route before rerouting, based on the reverting function supported by the ASON.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON trail must be created.

Background Information
l l l l ASON trails are classified into non-revertive ASON trails, automatically revertive ASON trails and scheduled revertive ASON trails. For non-revertive ASON trails, you can specify whether they are restored to timeslots or ports. For automatically revertive ASON trails, you can manually revert them to the routes before rerouting. For scheduled revertive ASON trails, a fault of the original route is cleared after the rerouting of a service in the scheduled reversion mode, you can set scheduled revertive time to enable the service to revert at a specified time.

Procedure
l For non-revertive ASON trails 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Optional: Click Filter to set the filter criteria and set Whether Original Route Is Active to No. Click Filter All. A dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails to be reverted. Click the Original Route tab to view the original routes of the ASON trails. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Check whether idle resources exist on the TE link of the original route. In the SDH ASON Trail Management window, click Maintenance and select Revert To Original Route > Revert to Port or Revert To Original > Revert to Timeslot. The ASON trails then revert to the routes before rerouting. A dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. The Restore to Port or Restore to Timeslot dialog box is displayed indicating the operation result. Click Close.
NOTE

6. 7.

You can click Retry to perform the restoration again.

For automatically revertive ASON trails and scheduled revertive ASON trail 1. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1-134

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

2. 3.

Optional: Click Filter to set the filter criteria and set Whether Original Route Is Active to No. Click Filter All. A dialog box is displayed. Click Yes. In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails to be reverted. Click Maintenance and select Manual Revert from the drop-down menu. The ASON trails then revert to the routes before rerouting.
NOTE

If the revertive mode is automatically revertive, you can set WTR time. When the original trail is restored, the service is automatically returned to the original trail after a period of time. If the revertive mode is scheduled revertive, you can set the scheduled revertive time after the original trail is restored. Before the scheduled reversion time expires, the service is automatically returned to the original trail.

----End

1.10.2 Optimizing an ASON Service


To manually adjust one or more service trails, you can use the optimization function to transfer the ASON service to the expected trails.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON trail must be created.

Background Information
l l l For a revertive silver service, you cannot perform the optimization operation when the service is being reverted upon rerouting. Diamond and non-diamond service cannot be optimized in batches at the same time. ASON service in different domains do not support optimization in batches.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, select one or more ASON trails that you want to adjust. Click Maintenance and choose Optimize Route from the drop-down menu. The wizard is displayed. Step 3 Specify the explicit nodes, explicit links, excluded nodes, or excluded links to set the trail after optimization. Step 4 Optional: To save the optimization settings, check the Save Optimization Settings check box. Step 5 Check whether the route adjustment is correctly set and click Apply. The Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Step 6 Click Close. A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation saves the current route as the original route.
NOTE

If you do not check the Set As Original Route Concurrently check box before clicking Apply, this dialog box is not displayed.

Step 7 Click Yes. The Operation Result dialog box is displayed. Click Close.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-135

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 8 In the trail list, select the trail after optimization. You can view the route information of the trail after optimization in the Actual Route. ----End

1.11 Migrating ASON Services


An ASON network supports the migration between traditional services and ASON services, and supports the in-service migration between ASON services at different levels. 1.11.1 Downgrading an ASON Service to a Traditional Service After an ASON service is converted to a traditional service, you can use the trail search function to manage the service in the SDH trail management. 1.11.2 Upgrading a Traditional Service to an ASON Service You can convert a traditional service to an ASON service. This section describes how to upgrade a traditional service to a non-revertive silver service. 1.11.3 Migration Between ASON Services The diamond service, gold service, silver service, and copper service can be migrated to each other. 1.11.4 Downgrading an ASON Server Trail to a Traditional Server Trail You can perform migration between an ASON server trail and a traditional server trail. 1.11.5 Upgrading a Traditional Server Trail to an ASON Server Trail You can upgrade a traditional server trail to an ASON server trail. 1.11.6 Migration Between ASON Server Trails The migration between the diamond tunnel, gold tunnel, silver tunnel, and copper tunnel is supported.

1.11.1 Downgrading an ASON Service to a Traditional Service


After an ASON service is converted to a traditional service, you can use the trail search function to manage the service in the SDH trail management.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON trail must be created.

Background Information
To convert the ASON route segment of an end-to-end trail that passes through an ASON network, perform the following operations: l l l
1-136

Navigate to the SDH Trail Management window. Delete the ASON trail segment of the trail from the network layer. Navigate to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. Convert the ASON trail segment of the trail to an SDH service. Use the SDH trail search function to search again and manage the trail.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, right-click the ASON trail that you want to convert and choose Downgrade to Traditional Service from the shortcut menu. In the confirmation dialog box displayed, click Yes. If an error message is displayed indicating that the ASON trail cannot be downgraded because it is managed by an SDH trail, this ASON service exists in the SDH Trail Management window. You need to right-click the service in the SDH Trail Management and choose Delete from Network Layer from the shortcut menu to downgrade it. Then, repeat Step 2.
NOTE

In this step, you can navigate to the SDH Trail Management window and view the ASON-SDH Trail field in the list to check if the trail passes an ASON domain. If the trail passes an AOSN domain, delete the service from the network layer and then downgrade it in the ASON Trail Management window.

Step 3 After the conversion, Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. You can search the service that is just converted.
NOTE

If you cannot search out this trail, wait for several minutes and search again. You can also synchronize the NE cross-connections on the SDH ASON topology.

----End

1.11.2 Upgrading a Traditional Service to an ASON Service


You can convert a traditional service to an ASON service. This section describes how to upgrade a traditional service to a non-revertive silver service.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. A traditional service must be configured on an ASON NE.

Background Information
l By default, SNCP services are converted to diamond services, MSP services are converted to gold services or downgraded gold services, non-protection services are converted to silver services, and protection timeslot services are converted to iron services. Inadaptable services such as broadcasting and unidirectional services cannot be upgraded to ASON services. If the entire trail exists on the ASON NE, you can upgrade the trail to an ASON trail. If only part of the trail exists on the ASON NE, you can upgrade only the trail segment that passes the ASON NE to an ASON trail. Partial upgrade means to upgrade part of the trail to an ASON service. Some part of the trail is not in the ASON domain, so you cannot upgrade the entire trail to an ASON service. Full upgrade is available for a trail that is within an ASON domain. A trail that is not within the ASON domain cannot be fully upgraded to an ASON service.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-137

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 2 In the list displayed, select one or more SDH trails that you want to upgrade. Right-click and choose Upgrade to ASON Trail from the shortcut menu. Step 3 In the dialog box displayed, enter the parameters of the ASON service. For example, l Class: Sliver. l Revertive Mode: Non-Revertive. l Rerouting Lockout: Unlocked. l Rerouting Priority: 2. l Rerouting Policy: Use existing trails whenever possible. Step 4 Select the trail that you want to upgrade and click OK. Step 5 Click OK in the confirmation dialog box. Step 6 A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click OK. ----End

1.11.3 Migration Between ASON Services


The diamond service, gold service, silver service, and copper service can be migrated to each other.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information
l l l l Silver services configured with the shared MESH restoration trail cannot be migrated. Associated services cannot be migrated to diamond services. The diamond service and gold service cannot be migrated to each other. This topic describes how to migrate a diamond service to a silver service. The procedure is similar to the migration between a diamond service and a gold, silver, copper service. Before you migrate an ASON service to a gold service, you need to create the MSP.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the list displayed, right-click the diamond service that you want to convert and choose InService Migration > Silver from the shortcut menu.

1-138

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 3 Click Yes in the Prompt dialog box. Step 4 The Confirm the route that you want to reserve dialog box is displayed. Confirm whether to reserve the working route or the protection route for the desired diamond ASON service, and correspondingly select Working Route or Protection Route.
NOTE

The route that you want to reserve can be selected only when a diamond service is migrated to a silver or copper service.

Step 5 Click Yes in the Prompt dialog box. Then, you can query the rerouting attributes of the ASON service as indicated. ----End

1.11.4 Downgrading an ASON Server Trail to a Traditional Server Trail


You can perform migration between an ASON server trail and a traditional server trail.

Prerequisite
l l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON server trail must be created.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-139

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Background Information
The two ways of migrating an ASON server trail are as follows: l l In the SDH Trail Management window, use the Downgrade to Traditional Service method to downgrade an ASON server trail. In the SDH ASON Trail Management window, use the Downgrade to Traditional Service method to downgrade an ASON server trail.

The following procedure describes how to migrate an ASON server trail to a traditional server trail in the second way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Right-click the ASON server trail that needs to be downgraded and choose Downgrade to Traditional Service from the shortcut menu. Click Yes in the confirmation dialog box. If a message is displayed indicating that The ASON trail that an SDH trail manages cannot be downgraded, it indicates that the ASON service exists in the SDH Trail Management window. You need to navigate to the SDH Trail Management window, right-click the ASON service and choose Delete from Network Layer from the shortcut menu. Repeat Step 2 to perform the downgrade operation again.
NOTE

In this step, you can view the value of ASON-SDH Trail in the SDH Trail Management window to determine whether the trail contains an ASON domain. If the trail contains an ASON domain, delete the service from the network layer and then downgrade the service in the ASON Trail Management window.

Step 3 A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 4 Optional: Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You cannot query the trail. Step 5 Optional: Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Select all ASON NEs and click Synchronize Cross-Connection. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 6 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next until the operation is complete. Step 7 Optional: Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the traditional server trail that is successfully migrated. ----End

1.11.5 Upgrading a Traditional Server Trail to an ASON Server Trail


You can upgrade a traditional server trail to an ASON server trail.

Prerequisite
l l
1-140

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. There must be at least two configured ASON NEs.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 In the list, select the traditional server trail that you want to migrate, right-click and choose Upgrade to ASON Trail from the shortcut menu. The Upgrade to ASON Trail dialog box is displayed. Step 3 Select the trail that you want to upgrade and click OK. Step 4 Click OK in the confirmation dialog box. Step 5 A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click OK. ----End

1.11.6 Migration Between ASON Server Trails


The migration between the diamond tunnel, gold tunnel, silver tunnel, and copper tunnel is supported.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Background Information
l l l The silver server trail that is configured with the shared mesh restoration trail cannot be migrated. The server trail that is associated with another trail cannot be migrated to diamond server trails. This topic considers the migration from the diamond server trail to the silver server trail as an example. The operations for the migration between the diamond server trail, gold server trail, silver server trail, and copper server trail are similar. Before you migrate a server trail into a gold server trail, however, you need to create the multiplex section.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select the diamond server trail to be migrated from the list. Right-click and choose In-Service Migration > Silver from the shortcut menu. Step 3 Click Yes in the Prompt dialog box. Step 4 The Confirm the route that you want to reserve dialog box is displayed. Select Working Route if you determine to reserve the working route of the diamond server trail that needs to be migrated. Select Protection Route if you need to reserve the protection route of the diamond server trail that needs to be migrated. Then, click OK.
NOTE

You need to select the route to be reserved only when you migrate the diamond server trail to the silver or copper server trail.

Step 5 Click Yes in the Prompt dialog box. Then, you can check the rerouting attributes of the ASON trails. ----End
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-141

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.12 Creating ASON Trail Groups


An ASON trail group is often used with LCAS.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON trail must be created.

Background Information
An ASON trail group associates the member trails that belong to the same LCAS service to an LSP group, and add, delete and modify these member trails in the ASON network. To enable virtual concatenation services to have an enhanced fault tolerance capability, separate the member trails whenever possible. Each ASON trail group has an ID, which is the unique ID assigned by an ASON NE. The member trails in the ASON trail group have the same source and sink, but the trails are separated whenever possible. You can create an ASON trail group at the initial node only.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-52. Create a GE service between NE1 and NE3, bind four VC4s to the service. Configure an EGT2 board each slot 4 of NE1 and NE3. Figure 1-52 ASON trail group service requirement
ASON trail group(4LSP) NE4

NE1

NE3

NE2

: ASON NE : LSP

Board Configuration
For the board configuration of NE1 and NE3, refer to Figure 1-53.

1-142

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-53 Board configuration of NE1 and NE3


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

EGT2

For the board configuration of NE2 and NE4, refer to Figure 1-54. Figure 1-54 Board configuration of NE2 and NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Service Planning
Refer to Table 1-31 for GE service planning.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-143

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-31 GE service planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Source VCTRUNK Bound bandwidth LCAS Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Sink VCTRUNK ASON trail group Member trail NE1<->NE3 NE1 4-EGT2-1 VC4-1 to VC4-4 VCTRUNK1 4 x VC4 Start NE3 4-EGT2-1 VC4-1 to VC4-4 VCTRUNK1 The group ID is 1 Four silver services from NE1-EGT2 to NE3-EGT2

Procedure
Step 1 In the Main Topology, right-click NE1 and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. Step 2 Select 4-EGT2 and set the interface parameters according to Table 1-31. Step 3 In the Main Topology, right-click NE3 and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. Step 4 Select 4-EGT2 and set the interface parameters according to Table 1-31. Step 5 Select four silver services from NE1-4-EGT2 to NE3-4-EGT2. Step 6 In the NE Explorer, select NE1 and choose ASON > ASON Trail Group from the Function Tree. Step 7 Click Create, and enter the ID, name and distance difference of the ASON trail group. Click Apply.

Step 8 Select the created ASON trail group and click Add. Step 9 Select the four created silver services and click OK. ----End
1-144 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.13 Creating Services Between an ASON NE and a Traditional NE


A network can consist of ASON NEs and traditional NEs. This realizes end-to-end service configuration and management. 1.13.1 Creating a VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain You can create end-to-end VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain. 1.13.2 Creating a VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain You can create end-to-end VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain. 1.13.3 Creating a VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE You can create end-to-end VC4 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs. 1.13.4 Creating a VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE You can create end-to-end VC12 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs. 1.13.5 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE You can create end-to-end 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs. 1.13.6 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE The 1+1 VC4 service can be configured between a traditional NE and an ASON NE. 1.13.7 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain You can create 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain. 1.13.8 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain You can create 1+1 VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain.

1.13.1 Creating a VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain
You can create end-to-end VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-55. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A VC4 service needs to be configured between NE5 and NE6. This service is required to be an unprotected service in the traditional network, but a silver service in the ASON network.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-145

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-55 VC4 service requirement between traditional NEs


NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

VC4 NE2 NE3

VC4 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-56 shows how the boards are configured on NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4. Figure 1-56 Board configuration for NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Figure 1-57 shows how the boards are configured on NE5 and NE6.

1-146

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-57 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
You can refer to Table 1-32 to plan a service. Table 1-32 VC4 service planning between traditional NEs Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Sink NE Sink board-port Sink VC4 Service route ASON service type Traditional service type NE6<->NE5 NE6 4-N1SL1-1 1 NE5 4-N1SL1-1 1 Automatically calculated by the system Silver Unprotected

You can use the following two ways to create a VC4 service between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain. l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Use the trail feature of the U2000 to directly create a VC4 service.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-147

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Create a silver service within the ASON domain. Then create VC4 cross-connections on NE5 and NE6.

The following illustrates how to create such a VC4 trail in the first way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail. Step 3 Enter the service information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source: NE6-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 l Sink: NE5-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1

Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and choose the Silver protection type.

1-148

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 5 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 6 In the SDH Trail Management window, click Filter and selectFilter All. Step 7 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the detailed route information of the VC4 trail that is created. You can also view the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 8 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.2 Creating a VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs that Cross an ASON Domain
You can create end-to-end VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-58. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A VC12 service needs to be configured between NE5 and NE6. This service is required to be an unprotected service in the traditional network, but a silver service in the ASON network. Figure 1-58 VC12 service requirement between traditional NEs
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

VC12 NE2 NE3

VC12 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-59 shows how the boards are configured on NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-149

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-59 Board configuration for NE1-NE4


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Figure 1-60 shows how the boards are configured on NE5 and NE6. Figure 1-60 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
You can refer to Table 1-33 to plan a service.

1-150

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-33 VC12 service planning between traditional NEs Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Source VC12 Sink NE Sink board-port Source VC4 Sink VC12 Service route ASON service type Traditional service type NE6<->NE5 (VC12) NE6 2-N1PQ1 1 NE5 2-N1PQ1 1 NE6<->NE5 (VC4 server trail) NE6 6-N1SL16-1 1 NE5 6-N1SL16-1 1 -

Automatically calculated by the system Silver Unprotected

You can use the following three ways to create a VC12 service between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain. l l l Use the trail feature of the U2000 to create a VC4 server trail first. Then create a VC12 trail. Create a silver trail within the ASON domain. Then create VC12 cross-connections on NE5 and NE6. Create a silver server trail within the ASON domain. Then create VC12 cross-connections on NE5 and NE6, and create VC12 cross-connections for both ends of the ASON server trail.

The following illustrates how to create such a VC12 trail in the first way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail to create a VC4 server trail. Step 3 Enter the VC4 server trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 Server Trail l Source: NE6 l Sink: NE5
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-151

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and choose the Silver protection type. Step 5 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 6 In the SDH Trail Creation view, enter the VC12 trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC12 l Source: NE6-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) l Sink: NE5-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) Step 7 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 8 In the SDH Trail Management window, click Filter and select Filter All. Step 9 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details of the VC4 server trail and the VC12 trail that are created. You can also view the value of ASONSDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 10 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.3 Creating a VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE


You can create end-to-end VC4 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-61. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A VC4 service needs to be configured between NE1 and NE5. This service is required to be an unprotected service in the traditional network, but a silver service in the ASON network. Figure 1-61 VC4 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs
NE1 VC4 NE6 NE5 NE4

VC4 NE2 NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

1-152

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Board Configuration
Figure 1-62 shows how the boards are configured on NE1, Figure 1-62 Board configuration for NE1
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N1SL1

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Figure 1-63 shows how the boards are configured on NE2, NE3 and NE4. Figure 1-63 Board configuration for NE2-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-153

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-64 shows how the boards are configured on NE5 and NE6. Figure 1-64 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
You can refer to Table 1-34 to plan a service. Table 1-34 VC4 service planning between traditional NE and ASON NE Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Sink NE Sink board-port Sink VC4 Service route ASON service type Traditional service type NE1<->NE5 NE1 4-N1SL1-1 1 NE5 4-N1SL1-1 1 Automatically calculated by the system Silver Unprotected

You can use the following two ways to create a VC4 service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE.
1-154 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l l

Use the trail feature of the U2000 to directly create a VC4 service. Create a silver service within the ASON domain. Then create VC4 cross-connections on NE5.

The following illustrates how to create such a VC4 trail in the first way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail. Step 3 Enter the service information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source: NE1-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 l Sink: NE5-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1

Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and choose the Silver protection type.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-155

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 5 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 6 In the SDH Trail Management window, click Filter and selectFilter All. Step 7 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the detailed route information of the VC4 trail that is created. You can also view the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 8 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.4 Creating a VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE


You can create end-to-end VC12 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-65. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A VC12 service needs to be configured between NE1 and NE5. This service is required to be an unprotected service in the traditional network, but a silver service in the ASON network. Figure 1-65 VC12 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs
NE1 VC12 NE6 NE5 NE4

VC12 NE2 NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-66 shows how the boards are configured on NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4.
1-156 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-66 Board configuration for NE1-NE4


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Figure 1-67 shows how the boards are configured on NE5 and NE6, Figure 1-67 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
You can refer to Table 1-35 and Table 1-36 to plan a service.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-157

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-35 Silver ASON server trail planning Attribute Source NE Sink NE Protection type Service Route NE1<->NE4 NE1 NE4 Silver ASON server trail Automatically calculated by the system

NOTE

You can query the board and timeslots occupied by the ASON server trail in the SDH ASON Trail Management window after the server trail is created. The example illustrated in this section is based on the assumption that NE1 occupies the first VC4 of 8-N2SL64-1, and NE4 occupies the first VC4 of 11N2SL64-1.

Table 1-36 VC12 service planning for NE1, NE4 and NE5 Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction NE5 CrossConnection 2-PQ1 1 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional NE1 CrossConnection 2-PQ1 1 8-N2SL64-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional NE4 CrossConnection 12-N1SL16-1 1 1 11-N2SL64-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional

Context
You can use the following two ways to create a VC12 service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE. l l Use the trail feature of the U2000 to create a VC4 server trail first. Then create a VC12 trail. Create a silver server trail between NE1 and NE4. Then create VC12 cross-connections on NE1, NE4 and NE5.

The following illustrates how to create such a VC12 trail in the first way.
1-158 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail to create a VC4 server trail. Step 3 Enter the VC4 server trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 Server Trail l Source: NE5 l Sink: E1 Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and choose the Silver protection type. Step 5 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 6 In the SDH Trail Creation view, enter the VC12 trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC12 l Source: NE5-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) l Sink: E1-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) Step 7 Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. Step 8 In the SDH Trail Management window, click Filter and select Filter All. Step 9 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the detailed information of the VC4 server trail and the VC12 trail that are created. You can also view the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 10 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.5 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE


You can create end-to-end 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs and ASON NEs.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be configured.

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-68. NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs. NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A VC12 service needs to be configured between NE1 and NE5. The service is required to be an SNCP service.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-159

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

The direction of the working service and protection service of the SNCP service between NE1 and NE5 must be the same. Figure 1-68 1+1 VC12 service requirement between traditional and ASON NEs
NE1 VC12 NE6 NE5 NE4

VC12 NE2 NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE : Working Trail : Protection trail

Board Configuration
Figure 1-69 shows how the boards are configured on NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4. Figure 1-69 Board configuration for NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Figure 1-70 shows how the boards are configured on NE5 and NE6,

1-160

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-70 Board configuration for NE5 and NE6


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
You can refer to Table 1-37, Table 1-38, Table 1-39 and Table 1-40 to plan a service. Table 1-37 Service planning for double silver ASON server trails Attribute Source NE Sink NE Protection type NE1<->NE4 NE1 NE4 Silver ASON server trail NE1<->NE3 NE1 NE3 Silver ASON server trail

Table 1-38 SNCP service planning for NE5 Attribute Transmit Direction Working service Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Receive Direction Working service 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

Protection service

2-PQ1 1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-161

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute

Transmit Direction Working service Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

Receive Direction Working service 2-PQ1 1 VC12 Unidirectional Protection service

Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction

6-N1SL16-1 1 1 VC12 Unidirectional

NOTE

You can query the boards and timeslots occupied by the two ASON server trails in the SDH ASON Trail Management window after the server trails are created. The example illustrated in this section is based on the assumption that NE1 occupies the 64 VC4 of 7-N2SL64-1 and the first VC4 of 8-N2SL64-1.

Table 1-39 SNCP service planning for NE1 Attribute Transmit Direction Working service Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction 2-PQ1 1 7-N2SL64-1 64 1 VC12 Unidirectional 8-N2SL64-1 1 Protection service Receive Direction Working service 7-N2SL64-1 64 1 2-PQ1 1 VC12 Unidirectional Protection service 8-N2SL64-1 1

NOTE

You can query the boards and timeslots occupied by the two ASON server trails in the SDH ASON Trail Management window after the server trails are created. The example illustrated in this section is based on the assumption that NE3 occupies the 64 VC4 of 7-N2SL64-1, and NE4 occupies the first VC4 of 11N2SL64-1.

1-162

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-40 Service planning for NE3 and NE4 Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction NE3 12-N1SL16-1 1 1 7-N2SL64-1 64 1 VC12 Bidirectional NE4 12-N1SL16-1 1 1 11-N2SL64-1 1 1 VC12 Bidirectional

You can use the following two ways to create a 1+1 VC12 service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE. l l Use the trail feature of the U2000 to create two VC4 server trails first. Then create VC12 trails. Create a silver ASON server trail between NE1 and NE4, and another silver ASON server trail between NE1 and NE3. Associate the two silver ASON server trails. Then create 1+1 VC12 cross-connections on NE1 and NE5, and create VC12 cross-connections on NE3 and NE4.

The following illustrates how to create such a 1+1 VC12 trail in the first way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create/Modify > Create Trail to create a VC4 server trail. Step 3 Create a VC4 server trail that passing NE5, NE4, and NE1 in sequence. 1. Enter the VC4 server trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 Server Trail l Source: NE5 l Sink: NE1 2. 3. 4. Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and select the Silver protection type. Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close.

Step 4 Create a VC4 server trail that passing NE5, NE3, and NE1 in sequence. 1.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Enter the VC4 server trail information as follows:


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-163

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 Server Trail l Source: NE5 l Sink: NE1 2. 3. 4. 5. 1. Select the fiber between NE5 and NE3, and route the service from NE5 to NE3, and then to NE1. Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings and select the Silver protection type. Click OK. Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close. In the SDH Trail Creation view, enter the VC12 trail information as follows: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC12 l Source: NE5-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) l Sink: NE1-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) 2. 3. 4. 5. Click the SNCP setting tab. Right-click NE5 and choose Set Dual-Fed Point from the shortcut menu. Right-click NE1 and choose Set Selective-Receiving Point from the shortcut menu. Check the Activate the trail check box and click Apply. The system prompts that the operation was successful. Click Close.

Step 5 Create a VC12 trail.

Step 6 In the SDH Trail Management window, click Filter and select Filter All. Step 7 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details about the VC4 server trail and the VC12 trail that are created. You can also view the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 8 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. You can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.6 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE


The 1+1 VC4 service can be configured between a traditional NE and an ASON NE.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON software of the ASON NE must be of version 5.99.7.1 or later.

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-71, NE1, NE2, NE3, and NE4 are ASON NEs whereas NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. A 1+1 VC4 service needs to be configured between NE5 and NE1. To implement
1-164 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

the 1+1 protection, the service association is configured in the ASON domain and the SNCP is configured on the traditional NEs. Figure 1-71 1+1 VC4 service requirement between a traditional NE and an ASON NE
NE1 VC4 NE4

NE6

NE5

VC4 NE2 NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-72 shows the board configuration of NE1-NE4. Figure 1-72 Board configuration of NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N1SL1

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-165

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-73 shows the board configuration of NE5 and NE6. Figure 1-73 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
Table 1-41, Table 1-42, Table 1-43, and Table 1-44 show the service planning for the NEs. Table 1-41 Service planning for the two silver ASON trails Attribute Source NE Sink NE Protection type NE1<->NE4 NE1 NE4 Silver trail NE1<->NE3 NE1 NE3 Silver trail

Table 1-42 SNCP service planning for NE5 Attribute Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port
1-166

Working Service 6-N1SL16-1 1 4-N1SL1-1

Protection Service 13-N1SL16-1

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction

Working Service 1 VC4 Bidirectional

Protection Service

NOTE

The boards and timeslots that the two ASON trails occupy can be queried in the SDH ASON Trail Management window only after the trails are created. In this example, the two ASON trails of NE1 occupy the 64th VC4 of the 7-N2SL64-1 and the first VC4 of the 8-N2SL64-1.

Table 1-43 SNCP service planning for NE1 Attribute Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink boardport Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction Working Service 7-N2SL64-1 64 4-N1SL1-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional Protection Service 8-N2SL64-1 1

NOTE

The boards and timeslots that the two ASON trails occupy can be queried in the SDH ASON Trail Management window only after the trails are created. In this example, the ASON trail of NE3 occupies the 64th VC4 of the 7-N2SL64-1 and the ASON trail of NE4 occupies the first VC4 of the 11-N2SL64-1.

Table 1-44 Service planning for NE3 and NE4 Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Service level
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

NE3 12-N1SL16-1 1 7-N2SL64-1 64 VC4


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

NE4 12-N1SL16-1 1 11-N2SL64-1 1 VC4


1-167

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Direction

NE3 Bidirectional

NE4 Bidirectional

To create the 1+1 VC4 service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE, do as follows: Create a silver ASON trail between NE1 and NE4 and create a silver ASON trail between NE1 and NE3. Then, associate the two ASON trails. After that, create the 1+1 VC4 cross-connection between NE1 and NE5, and create the VC4 cross-connection between NE3 and NE4.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, enter the following attributes: l Name: NE1-NE4-ASON-Trail-0001 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Silver l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, enter the following attributes: l Revetrive Mode: Revertive (Select Non-Revetrive if the silver service is a non-revetrive service. Select Scheduled revertive if the silver service is a scheduled revertive service.) l Priority: 1 l Lockout: Unlocked l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the N1SL16 in slot 6, port 1, and timeslot 1. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Ensure that the trail information and routing restrictions are correct. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful.
1-168 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 9 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 10 According to the service planning, repeat Steps 3-9 to create the silver service between NE1 and NE3. Step 11 Click Cancel to return to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. Hold down the Ctrl key and select the two silver trails to be associated. Right-click and choose Set Association from the shortcut menu. Click Yes in the Prompt dialog box that is displayed. After the two ASON trails are associated, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Step 12 Select the NE1 icon in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. Step 13 Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Step 14 Click Create SNCP Service and enter the following SNCP service information about NE1: l Service Type: SNCP l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: Working Service: 7-N2SL64-1 Protection Service: 8-N2SL64-1 l Source Timeslot Range: Working Service: 64 Protection Service: 1 l Sink Slot: 4-N1SL1-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 1 Step 15 Click Apply. After the SNCP service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Step 16 According to the service planning, repeat Steps 12-15 to create the SNCP service of NE5. ? Step 17 Enter the NE Explorer of NE3. Step 18 Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Step 19 Click Create and enter the following SDH service information about NE3: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: 12-N1SL16-1 l Source Timeslot Range: 1 l Sink Slot: 7-N2SL64-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 64 l Activate Immediately: Yes Step 20 Click OK. After the SDH service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-169

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 21 According to the service planning, repeat Steps 17-20 to create the SDH service of NE4. Step 22 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next one after another until the search is complete. Check whether the trail is created successfully in the SDH Trail Management window. Step 23 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Filter and choose Filter All. Check the detailed information about the trail that is created. Step 24 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Then, you can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.13.7 Creating a 1+1 VC12 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain
You can create 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON NE must be configured.

Service Requirement
In Figure 1-74, NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs, and NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. Configure a VC12 service between NE5 and NE6. The service requires SNCP protection. Figure 1-74 1+1 VC12 service requirement between traditional NEs
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

VC12 NE2 NE3

VC12 : ASON NE : Traditional NE : Working Trail : Protection trail

Board Configuration
For the board configuration of NE1-NE4, refer to Figure 1-75.
1-170 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-75 Board configuration of NE1-NE4


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

For the board configuration of NE5 and NE6, refer to Figure 1-76. Figure 1-76 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
Refer to Table 1-45, Table 1-46 and Table 1-47 for service planning.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-171

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Table 1-45 Planning of two silver ASON trails Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Sink NE Sink board-port Sink VC4 Protection type Service type Trail type NE1<->NE4 NE1 12-N1SL16-1 1 NE4 12-N1SL16-1 1 Silver ASON trail Working trail NE2<->NE3 NE2 12-N1SL16-1 1 NE3 12-N1SL16-1 1 Silver ASON trail Protection trail

Table 1-46 SNCP service planning of NE5 Attribute Transmit direction Working service Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction 2-PQ1 1 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 VC12 Unidirectional 13-N1SL16-1 Protection service Receive direction Working service 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 2-PQ1 1 VC12 Unidirectional Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

1-172

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-47 SNCP service planning of NE6 Attribute Transmit direction Working service Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Source VC12 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Sink VC12 timeslot Service level Direction 2-PQ1 1 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 VC12 Unidirectional 13-N1SL16-1 Protection service Receive direction Working service 6-N1SL16-1 1 1 2-PQ1 1 VC12 Unidirectional Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

The two ways of creating 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain are as follows: l l Use the trail function of the U2000 to create two VC4 server trails and then create a VC12 trail. Create a silver ASON trail between NE1 and NE4 and a silver ASON trail between NE2 and NE3. Associate these two silver ASON trails. Configure VC12 cross-connections for NE5 and NE6.

The following procedure describes how to create 1+1 VC12 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain in the first way.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Select Create/Modify > Create Trail to create a VC4 server trail. Step 3 Create a VC4 server trail from NE5, NE4, NE1 to NE6. 1. Enter the information of the VC4 server trail. For example: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 server trail l Source: NE5 l Sink: NE6
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-173

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2. 3. 4. 1.

Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings. Select Silver as the protection type and click OK. Check the Activate the trail check box. Click Apply. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Enter the information of the VC4 server trail. For example: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 server trail l Source: NE5 l Sink: NE6

Step 4 Create a VC4 server trail from NE5, NE3, NE1 to NE6.

2. 3. 4. 5. 1.

Select the fiber between NE3 and NE2, and adjust the route to pass NE3 and NE2 and reach NE1. Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and select Silver as the protection type. Check the Activate the trail check box. Click Apply. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. In the SDH Trail Creation View, enter the information of the VC12 trail. For example: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC12 l Source: NE5-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1) l Sink: NE6-2-PQ1-1(SDH_TU-1)

Step 5 Create a VC12 trail.

2. 3. 4. 5.

Click the SNCP setting tab. Right-click NE5 and choose Set Dual-Fed Point from the shortcut menu. Right-click NE6 and choose Set Selective-Receiving Point from the shortcut menu. Check the Activate the trail check box. Click Apply. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close.

Step 6 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Filter and select Filter All. Step 7 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details of the VC4 server trail and the VC12 trail that are created. View the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 8 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. View the information of the created ASON trail. ----End

1.13.8 Creating a 1+1 VC4 Service Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain
You can create 1+1 VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain.
1-174 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON NE must be configured.

Service Requirement
In Figure 1-77, NE1, NE2, NE3 and NE4 are ASON NEs, and NE5 and NE6 are traditional NEs. Configure a VC4 service between NE5 and NE6. The service requires SNCP protection. Figure 1-77 1+1 VC4 service requirement between traditional NEs
NE1 NE4

NE6

NE5

VC4 NE2 NE3

VC4 : ASON NE : Traditional NE : Working Trail : Protection trail

Board Configuration
For the board configuration of NE1-NE4, refer to Figure 1-78. Figure 1-78 Board configuration of NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-175

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

For the board configuration of NE5 and NE6, refer to Figure 1-79. Figure 1-79 Board configuration of NE5 and NE6
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SL16

EXCSA

N1SL1

Service Planning
Refer to Table 1-48, Table 1-49 and Table 1-50 for service planning. Table 1-48 Planning of Two Silver ASON Trails Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Sink NE Sink board-port Sink VC4 Protection type Service type Trail type NE1<->NE4 NE1 12-N1SL16-1 1 NE4 12-N1SL16-1 1 Silver ASON trail Working trail NE2<->NE3 NE2 12-N1SL16-1 1 NE3 12-N1SL16-1 1 Silver ASON trail Protection trail

1-176

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-49 SNCP service planning of NE5 Attribute Transmit direction Working service Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction 5-N1SL16-1 2 6-N1SL16-1 2 VC4 Unidirectional 13-N1SL16-1 Protection service Receive direction Working service 6-N1SL16-1 2 5- N1SL16-1 2 VC4 Unidirectional Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

Table 1-50 SNCP service planning of NE6 Attribute Transmit direction Working service Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction 5- N1SL16-1 2 6-N1SL16-1 2 VC4 Unidirectional 13-N1SL16-1 Protection service Receive direction Working service 6-N1SL16-1 2 5- N1SL16-1 2 VC4 Unidirectional Protection service 13-N1SL16-1

The two ways of creating 1+1 VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain are as follows: l l Use the trail function of the U2000 to create a VC4 service. Create a silver ASON trail between NE1 and NE4 and a silver ASON trail between NE2 and NE3. Associate these two silver ASON trails. Configure VC4 cross-connections for NE5 and NE6.

The following procedure describes how to 1+1 VC4 services between traditional NEs that cross an ASON domain in the first way.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-177

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Select Create/Modify > Create Trail. Step 3 Enter the information of the service. For example: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source: NE5-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 l Sink: NE6-4-N1SL1-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and select Silver as the protection type. Step 5 Click the SNCP setting tab. Right-click NE5 and choose Set Dual-Fed Point from the shortcut menu. Step 6 Right-click NE6 and choose Set Selective-Receiving Point from the shortcut menu. Step 7 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and select Silver as the protection type. Step 8 Check the Activate the trail check box. Click Apply. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 9 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Filter and select Filter All. Step 10 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details of the created VC4 trail. View the value of ASON-SDH Trail to check whether the ASON section of the ASON-SDH trail is successfully created. Step 11 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. View the information of the created ASON trail. ----End

1.14 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Through Linear MSP


When accessing services from a traditional network, to ensure that reliability of the accessed services, you can create a 1+1 or 1:1 linear MSP at the edge of the traditional network and an ASON domain. You can configure services in an ASON domain to the diamond , gold, and silver level.

Prerequisite
l l
1-178

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON NE must be configured.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Service Requirement
See Figure 1-80. If services exist between NE5 and NE3, a 1+1 linear MSP between NE5 and NE2 can ensure the reliability of services accessed from the source node NE5. Figure 1-80 Accessing 1+1 linear MSP
NE1 NE4

NE5

1+1 Linear MS NE2 NE3 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
For the board configuration of NE1 and NE4, refer to Figure 1-81. Figure 1-81 Board configuration of NE1 and NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

For the board configuration of NE2 and NE3, refer to Figure 1-82.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-179

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-82 Board configuration of NE2 and NE3


S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N2SL64 N2SL64

N1SL16

EXCSA

For the board configuration of NE5, refer to Figure 1-83. Figure 1-83 Board configuration of NE5
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16 N1SL16

N1SL16 N1SL16

EXCSA

Service Planning
Refer to Table 1-51 for service planning.

1-180

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-51 Planning of Diamond Services Accessed Through 1+1 Linear MSP Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source VC4 Sink NE Sink board-port Sink VC4 Service route ASON service type Traditional service type NE5<->NE3 NE5 14-N1SL16-1 1 NE3 5-N1SL16-1 1 The system automatically calculates the service route. Diamond 1+1 linear MSP

NOTE

In this case, a 1+1 linear MSP is created between NE5 and NE2.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Step 2 Select Create/Modify > Create Trail. Step 3 Enter the information of the service. l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source: NE5-14-N1SL16-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 l Sink: NE3-5-N1SL16-1(SDH-1)-VC4:1 Step 4 Check the SPC First check box. Click ASON Attributes Settings tab and select Diamond as the protection type. Step 5 Check the Activate the trail check box. Click Apply. A prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 6 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next and click Finish. Step 7 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the details of the created VC4 trail. Step 8 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. View the information of the created ASON trail. ----End
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-181

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.15 Accessing a Traditional Network to an ASON Network by Using the SNCP Accessed Service
When a traditional network is accessed to an ASON network by using the SNCP accessed service, the end-to-end SNCP is implemented for the service. 1.15.1 Creating the SNCP Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE To configure the SNCP service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE, you need to configure the SNCP in the traditional network and configure the diamond service, gold service, silver service, copper service, or iron service in the ASON network. 1.15.2 Creating SNCP Services Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain To configure the SNCP services between traditional NEs that cross the ASON domain, you need to configure the SNCP in the traditional network and configure the diamond service, gold service, or silver service in the ASON network. 1.15.3 Querying the Information About the SNCP Accessed Service After the SNCP accessed service is created, you can query the relevant information, such as the access point and switching status. 1.15.4 Performing Switching at the SNCP Access End After the SNCP accessed service is created, you can perform switching at the SNCP access end.

1.15.1 Creating the SNCP Service Between a Traditional NE and an ASON NE


To configure the SNCP service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE, you need to configure the SNCP in the traditional network and configure the diamond service, gold service, silver service, copper service, or iron service in the ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON software of the ASON NE must be of version 5.99.7.1 or later.

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-84, a VC4 service is configured between NE5 and NE3. This VC4 service is configured with SNCP in the traditional network between NE5 and NE1 and is configured as a diamond service in the ASON network between NE1 and NE3.

1-182

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-84 SNCP service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE


NE6 SNCP access NE4

NE5 SDH ASON NE3 NE1

NE7

NE2 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-85 shows the board configuration of NE1-NE4. Figure 1-85 Board configuration of NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N1SLD4

N1SL16 N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-183

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-86 shows the board configuration of NE5-NE7. Figure 1-86 Board configuration of NE5-NE7
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SLD4

N1SL16

EXCSA

Service Planning
Table 1-52, Table 1-53, and Table 1-54 show the service planning for the NEs. Table 1-52 Planning of the diamond service between NE1 and NE3 Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class SNCP Access Route constraint NE1<->NE3 NE1 4-N1SLD4-1 1 NE3 4-N1SLD4-1 1 Diamond Source: NE1-12-N1SL16-1VC4:1 Working path: NE1-NE4NE3; protection path: NE1NE2-NE3 Revertive attribute Non-revertive
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Rerouting attributes
1-184

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Attribute Rerouting trigger condition Rerouting policy Rerouting Hold-off time

NE1<->NE3 Initiates rerouting if any one of the LSPs is interrupted. Use existing trails whenever possible 0

Table 1-53 SNCP service planning for NE1 and NE5 Attribute Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink boardport Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction Working Service 6-N1SL16-1 1 4-N1SLD4-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional Protection Service 12-N1SL16-1 1

Table 1-54 Service planning for NE6 and NE7 Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction NE6 12-N1SL16-1 1 6-N1SL16-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional NE7 12-N1SL16-1 1 12-N1SL16-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional

To configure the SNCP service between a traditional NE and an ASON NE, do as follows: Create a diamond ASON trail between NE1 and NE3 (NE1 and NE3 need to be configured with the SNCP accessed service). Create the SNCP services on NE1 and NE5. Then, configure the SDH services on NE6 and NE7. Search the trail by using the trail search function.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-185

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 To create the diamond service between NE1 and NE3, do as follows: 1. 2. 3. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Click Create to enter the creation wizard window. Enter the following basic information aboutthe trail in the Basic Information column: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0001 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Diamond l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation 4. In the Routing Attributes field, set the rerouting attributes of the trail. l Revetrive Mode: Non-Revetrive (Select Revertive if the diamond service is a revertive service. Select Scheduled revertive if the diamond service is a scheduled revertive service.) l Priority: 1 l Lockout: Unlocked l Trigger Condition: Reroute when one trail fails l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 5. 6. 7. Set the source NE. In the topology view on the right, double-click the sink NE and select the slot, port, and timeslot in the dialog box that is displayed. Click OK. Set the sink NE. In the topology view on the right, double-click the sink NE and select the slot, port, and timeslot in the dialog box that is displayed. Click OK. In the Basic Information column, set the working/protection route of the diamond service. l Select the Working option button. Right-click NE4 in the topology view on the right and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. l Select the Protection option button. Right-click NE2 in the topology view on the right and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. 8. 9. Add the source access point NE1-12-N1SL16-1-VC4:1 in the SNCP Access column. Ensure that the trail information and route restrictions are correct. Click Apply. After the creation is complete, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Select the NE1 icon in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu. Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Click Create SNCP Service and enter the following SNCP service information aboutNE1: l Service Type: SNCP l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: Working Service: 6-N1SL16-1 Protection Service: 12-N1SL16-1
1-186 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Step 2 To configure the SNCP services of NE1 and NE5, do as follows: 1. 2. 3.

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l Source Timeslot Range: Working Service: 1 Protection Service: 1 l Sink Slot: 4-N1SLD4-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 1 4. 5. Click Apply. After the SNCP service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. According to the service planning, repeat Steps 1-4 to create the SNCP service of NE5.

Step 3 To configure the SDH services of NE6 and NE7, do as follows: 1. 2. 3. Enter the NE Explorer of NE6. Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Click Create and enter the following SDH service information aboutNE6: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: 12-N1SL16-1 l Source Timeslot Range: 1 l Sink Slot: 6-N1SL16-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 1 l Activate Immediately: Yes 4. 5. Click OK. After the SDH service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. According to the service planning, repeat Steps 1-4 to create the SDH service of NE7.

Step 4 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next one after another until the search is complete. Check whether the trail is created successfully in the SDH Trail Management window. Step 5 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Filter and choose Filter All. Then, you can view the detailed information aboutthe trail that is created. Step 6 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Then, you can view the ASON trail information. ----End

1.15.2 Creating SNCP Services Between Traditional NEs That Cross an ASON Domain
To configure the SNCP services between traditional NEs that cross the ASON domain, you need to configure the SNCP in the traditional network and configure the diamond service, gold service, or silver service in the ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON software of the ASON NE must be of version 5.99.7.1 or later.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-187

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-87, a VC4 service is configured between NE5 and NE9. This VC4 service is configured with the SNCP in the traditional network between NE5 and NE1 and in the traditional network between NE3 and NE9, and is configured as a diamond service in the ASON network between NE1 and NE3. Figure 1-87 SNCP services between traditional NEs that cross the ASON domain
NE7 SNCP access NE4 SNCP access NE10

NE5 SDH NE1

ASON NE3

SDH

NE9

NE6

NE2

NE8 : ASON NE : Traditional NE

Board Configuration
Figure 1-88 shows the board configuration of NE1-NE4. Figure 1-88 Board configuration of NE1-NE4
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N2SL64 N1SL16

N1SLD4

N1SL16 N2SL64 N2SL64

EXCSA

1-188

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-89 shows the board configuration of NE5-NE10. Figure 1-89 Board configuration of NE5-NE10
S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 S 2 8 S S S S S S S S S 2 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

D75S D75S

FAN S S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

FAN S 1 0
EXCSA

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
N1SL16

N1SLD4

N1SL16

EXCSA

Service Planning
Table 1-55, Table 1-56, and Table 1-57 show the service planning for the NEs. Table 1-55 Planning of the diamond service between NE1 and NE3 Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class SNCP access NE1<->NE3 NE1 4-N1SLD4-1 1 NE3 4-N1SLD4-1 1 Diamond Source: NE1-12-N1SL16-1VC4:1 Sink: NE3-12-N1SL16-1VC4:1

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

GSCC GSCC

PQ1 PQ1

AUX

PIU

PIU

1-189

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Attribute Route constraint

NE1<->NE3 Working path: NE1-NE4NE3; protection path: NE1NE2-NE3 Revertive attribute Rerouting trigger condition Rerouting policy Rerouting Hold-off time Non-revertive Initiates rerouting if any one of the LSPs is interrupted. Use existing trails whenever possible 0

Rerouting attributes

Table 1-56 SNCP service planning for NE1, NE3, NE5, and NE9 Attribute Source boardport Source VC4 timeslot Sink boardport Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction Working Service 6-N1SL16-1 1 4-N1SLD4-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional Protection Service 12-N1SL16-1 1

Table 1-57 Service planning for NE6, NE7, NE8, and NE10 Attribute Source board-port Source VC4 timeslot Sink board-port Sink VC4 timeslot Service level Direction NE 6-N1SL16-1 1 12-N1SL16-1 1 VC4 Bidirectional

1-190

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

To configure the SNCP services between traditional NEs that cross the ASON domain, do as follows: Create a diamond ASON trail between NE1 and NE3 (NE1 and NE3 need to be configured with the SNCP accessed service). Create the SNCP services of NE1, NE3, NE5, and NE9. Then, configure the SDH services of NE6, NE7, NE8, and NE10. Search the trail by using the trail search function.

Procedure
Step 1 To create the diamond service between NE1 and NE3, do as follows: 1. 2. 3. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Click Create to enter the creation wizard window. Enter the following basic information aboutthe trail in the Basic Information column: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0001 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Diamond l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation 4. In the Routing Attributes field, set the rerouting attributes of the trail. l Revetrive Mode: Non-Revetrive (Select Revertive if the diamond service is a revertive service. Select Scheduled revertive if the diamond service is a scheduled revertive service.) l Priority: 1 l Lockout: Unlocked l Trigger Condition: Reroute when one trail fails l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible l Rerouting Hold-off time: 0 5. 6. 7. Set the source NE. In the topology view on the right, double-click the sink NE and select the slot, port, and timeslot in the dialog box that is displayed. Click OK. Set the sink NE. In the topology view on the right, double-click the sink NE and select the slot, port, and timeslot in the dialog box that is displayed. Click OK. Set the working/protection route for the diamond service in the Basic Information column. l Select the Working option button. Right-click NE4 in the topology view on the right and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. l Select the Protection option button. Right-click NE2 in the topology view on the right and choose Set As Explicit Node from the shortcut menu. 8. Enter the following SNCP access information in the SNCP Access column: l Source: NE1-12-N1SL16-1-VC4:1 l Sink: NE3-12-N1SL16-1-VC4:1 9. Ensure that the trail information and route restrictions are correct. Click Apply. After the creation is complete, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful.

Step 2 To configure the SNCP services of NE1, NE3, NE5, and NE9, do as follows: 1. Select the NE1 icon in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the shortcut menu.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-191

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2. 3.

Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Click Create SNCP Service and enter the following SNCP service information aboutNE1: l Service Type: SNCP l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: Working Service: 6-N1SL16-1 Protection Service: 12-N1SL16-1 l Source Timeslot Range: Working Service: 1 Protection Service: 1 l Sink Slot: 4-N1SLD4-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 1

4. 5.

Click Apply. After the SNCP service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. According to the service planning, repeat Steps 1-4 to create the SNCP services of NE3, NE5, and NE9.

Step 3 To configure the SNCP services of NE6, NE7, NE8, and NE10, do as follows: 1. 2. 3. Enter the NE Explorer of NE6. Choose Configuration > SDH Service Configuration from the Function Tree. Click Create and enter the following SDH service information aboutNE6: l Direction: Bidirectional l Level: VC4 l Source Slot: 12-N1SL16-1 l Source Timeslot Range: 1 l Sink Slot: 6-N1SL16-1 l Sink Timeslot Range: 1 l Activate Immediately: Yes 4. 5. Click OK. After the SDH service is created, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. According to the service planning, repeat Steps 1-4 to create the SDH services of NE7, NE8, and NE10.

Step 4 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Next one after another until the search is complete. Check whether the trail is created successfully in the SDH Trail Management window. Step 5 Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. Click Filter and choose Filter All. Check the detailed information aboutthe trail that is created. Step 6 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Then, you can view the ASON trail information. ----End
1-192 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.15.3 Querying the Information About the SNCP Accessed Service


After the SNCP accessed service is created, you can query the relevant information, such as the access point and switching status.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The unidirectional SNCP accessed service or bidirectional SNCP accessed service must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select the SNCP accessed ASON service to be queried. Choose Maintenance > SNCP Accessed Service. Step 3 In SNCP Accessed Service, click Query Switching Status.

Step 4 After the query is performed successfully, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click to close the window. ----End

1.15.4 Performing Switching at the SNCP Access End


After the SNCP accessed service is created, you can perform switching at the SNCP access end.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The unidirectional SNCP accessed service or bidirectional SNCP accessed service must be created.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-193

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Select the ASON service for which switching needs to be performed at the SNCP access end. Choose Maintenance > SNCP Accessed Service. Step 3 Select the access point where switching needs to be performed. Click Access Point Switching. Step 4 After switching is performed successfully, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation to close the window. Then, you can check that switching is already is successful. Click performed at the access point of Selective Receiving End. ----End

1.16 Managing UNI Services


The UNI is the standard interface that is used to connect the client equipment to the transport network. When the UNI is used, the client equipment can dynamically request transport resources from the transport network and release transport resources to the transport network, by using the control signalling. Configuring UNI services is simpler and takes less time than configuring traditional services. UNI services improve the reliability and real-time performance of the transport network so that burst data service requirements can be met and end-to-end UNI services can be realized.

Context
The ASON NE of the USP V100R005 version not support the UNI function. 1.16.1 Flow of Configuring UNI Services The UNI (logical user-network interface) services are available in two types, namely, generalized multi-protocol label switching (GMPLS) UNI services and Optical Internetworking Forum (OIF) UNI services. The flow of configuring GMPLS UNI services is different from the flow of configuring OIF UNI services. 1.16.2 Enabling the UNI Feature of an ASON NE After an ASON NE is activated, the UNI services can be created only after the UNI feature is enabled. 1.16.3 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI The GMPLS UNI is a standard UNI specified by the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF). The GMPLS UNI inherits the normal LSP features, including the creating, deleting, protecting, and restoring the LSP. 1.16.4 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI The OIF UNI is the standard UNI specified by the OIF. The OIF UNI has similar functions to the GMPLS UNI. 1.16.5 Setting the UNI Access Policy In the case of an ASON network, the management strategy can be customized according the requirements of the UNI users. In addition, the user name and password, and the restrictions on the service creation can be set according to the requirements of the UNI users. 1.16.6 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI Link In the case of the GMPLS UNI, you need to set the information such as the IP address.
1-194 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.16.7 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI Link In the case of the OIF UNI, you need to set the information such as the transport network address (TNA). 1.16.8 Querying UNI Services You can query the detailed information about the services that UNI users create, by using the U2000. 1.16.9 Deleting UNI Services You can manually delete the services that the UNI users create, by using the U2000.

1.16.1 Flow of Configuring UNI Services


The UNI (logical user-network interface) services are available in two types, namely, generalized multi-protocol label switching (GMPLS) UNI services and Optical Internetworking Forum (OIF) UNI services. The flow of configuring GMPLS UNI services is different from the flow of configuring OIF UNI services. In the case of UNI services, the ASON NE is generally considered as the UNI-N side. In this case, the flow of configuring the UNI services is shown in Figure 1-90.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-195

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-90 Flow of configuring UNI services


Start

Enable the UNI feature

Configure the UNI

Configure the UNI access policy

Determine the signaling protocol type OIF

GMPLS

Create the GMPLS UNI link

Create the OIF UNI link

The UNI-C initiates the service creation The UNI-N automatically creates the UNI service Query the UNI services on the T2000

End

1.16.2 Enabling the UNI Feature of an ASON NE


After an ASON NE is activated, the UNI services can be created only after the UNI feature is enabled.

Prerequisite
l l The ASON feature must be enabled for the ASON NE. You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

1-196

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 In the NE Explorer, select NE1 and then choose ASON > UNI Management from the Function Tree. Click UNI Feature Management. Step 3 Click Query to query the current status of the ASON feature. Step 4 Set UNI Feature to Enabled.

NOTE

To disable the ASON feature of NE1, set UNI Feature to Disabled.

Step 5 Click Apply. Step 6 Repeat Steps 1-4 to enable the UNI feature of NE3. ----End

1.16.3 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI


The GMPLS UNI is a standard UNI specified by the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF). The GMPLS UNI inherits the normal LSP features, including the creating, deleting, protecting, and restoring the LSP.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-91, NE1 and NE3 are connected to two routers through the GMPLS UNIs. The information about the GMPLS UNI must be set for NE1 and NE3 so that the routers can be created dynamically and the LSP link between the routers can be managed.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-197

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-91 Setting the information about the GMPLS UNI


NE4

GMPLS UNI NE1

NE3

GMPLS UNI

NE2 ASON NE

Router

Board Configuration
Figure 1-92 shows the board configuration of NE1. Figure 1-93 shows the board configuration of NE3. The JL64 board in slot 1 of NE1 is connected to the T2SL64 board in slot 11 of NE3. The JL64 board in slot 6 of NE1 is connected to one router and the N1SL16 board in slot 13 of NE3 is connected to the other router. Figure 1-92 Board configuration of NE1
S S S 1 2 3 S S 4 5 S S S S S 6 7 8 9 1 0 S 1 1 S S 1 1 2 3 S S S 1 1 1 4 5 6 S S S 5 5 4 5 1 7 S S 4 3 8 3 S S S S 3 4 4 3 4 1 2 5 S 3 6 S 5 8 S S 5 5 2 6

GXCH

GXCH

JEOW

JSCC

JSCC

EMPU

JL64

JL64

JL64

JL64

S S 1 1 7 8

S 1 9

S S 2 2 0 1

S S S S S 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 4 5 6

S 2 7

S S 2 2 8 9

S S S 3 3 3 0 1 2

S S 5 4 3 9

S 5 0

S S 5 3 4 7

S S S S 3 4 4 3 8 3 4 9

S 4 0

S 4 5

S S 4 5 6 7

GXCH GXCH

Front

Rear

1-198

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

JSTG JPIU

JPIU

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Figure 1-93 Board configuration of NE3


S S S S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 S 3 1 S S 3 3 2 4
PIU EOW GSCC GSCC

S S S S 3 3 3 3 5 6 7 8

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 S 9
T1EXCSA

FAN S 1 0
T1EXCSA

PIU

S 3 3

AUX

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
T2SL64 N1SL16 N1SL16

Service Planning Procedure


Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 Click NE1 in the NE Explorer. Choose ASON > UNI Management > UNI interface Management from the Function Tree. Step 3 Select the board and port whose attributes need to be set. Set Interface Attributes to GMPLS UNI-N Attributes.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-199

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 4 Click Apply. Step 5 Repeat Steps 1-4 to set attributes of the GMPLS UNI of NE3. ----End

1.16.4 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI


The OIF UNI is the standard UNI specified by the OIF. The OIF UNI has similar functions to the GMPLS UNI.

Prerequisite
l l The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled. You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-94, NE1 and NE3 are connected to two routers through the OIF UNIs. The information about the OIF UNI must be set for NE1 and NE3 so that the routers can be created dynamically and the LSP link between the routers can be managed. Figure 1-94 Setting the information about the OIF UNI
NE4

OIF UNI

NE1

NE3

OIF UNI

NE2 ASON NE

Router

1-200

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Board Configuration
Figure 1-95 shows the board configuration of NE1. Figure 1-96 shows the board configuration of NE3. The JL64 board in slot 1 of NE1 is connected to the T2SL64 board in slot 11 of NE3. The JL64 board in slot 5 of NE1 is connected to one router and the N1SL16 board in slot 12 of NE3 is connected to the other router. Figure 1-95 Board configuration of NE1
S S S 1 2 3 S S 4 5 S S S S S 6 7 8 9 1 0 S 1 1 S S 1 1 2 3 S S S 1 1 1 4 5 6 S S S 5 5 4 5 1 7 S S 4 3 8 3 S S S S 3 4 4 3 4 1 2 5 S 3 6 S 5 8 S S 5 5 2 6

GXCH

GXCH

JEOW

JSCC

JSCC

EMPU

JL64

JL64

JL64

JL64

S S 1 1 7 8

S 1 9

S S 2 2 0 1

S S S S S 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 4 5 6

S 2 7

S S 2 2 8 9

S S S 3 3 3 0 1 2

S S 5 4 3 9

S 5 0

S S 5 3 4 7

S S S S 3 4 4 3 8 3 4 9

S 4 0

S 4 5

S S 4 5 6 7

GXCH GXCH

Front

Rear

Figure 1-96 Board configuration of NE3


S S S S S S S S S S S S 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 3 9 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 S 3 1 S S 3 3 2 4
PIU

S S S S 3 3 3 3 5 6 7 8

EOW GSCC GSCC

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 S 9
T1EXCSA

FAN S 1 0
T1EXCSA

PIU

S 3 3

AUX

FAN S S S S S S S S 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
T2SL64 N1SL16 N1SL16

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-201

JSTG JPIU

JPIU

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Service Planning Procedure


Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 Click NE1 in the NE Explorer. Choose ASON > UNI Management > UNI interface Management from the Function Tree. Step 3 Select the board and port whose attributes need to be set. Set Interface Attributes to OIF UNIN Attributes.

Step 4 Click Apply. Step 5 Repeat Steps 1-4 to set attributes of the OIF UNI of NE3. ----End

1.16.5 Setting the UNI Access Policy


In the case of an ASON network, the management strategy can be customized according the requirements of the UNI users. In addition, the user name and password, and the restrictions on the service creation can be set according to the requirements of the UNI users.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

otherprops="u2klct;lct"The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 Click NE1 in the NE Explorer. Choose ASON > UNI Management > UNI Access Policy Management from the Function Tree. Step 3 Click the UNI Access Policy Management tab. Click Create. Enter the information about the UNI access policy in the Create UNI Access Policy Management dialog box that is displayed. Set the following information:
1-202 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l User: szhw l password: nwsoft l Color: 0 l Maximum Bandwidth(M): 10000 l Minimum Service Creation Interval: 30

Step 4 Click Apply. Step 5 Repeat Steps 1-4 to set the UNI access policy of NE3. ----End

1.16.6 Setting the Information About the GMPLS UNI Link


In the case of the GMPLS UNI, you need to set the information such as the IP address.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled. The GMPLS UNI must be configured.

Procedure
Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 Click NE1 in the NE Explorer. Choose ASON > UNI Management > IP Address Management of GMPLS UNI Link from the Function Tree. Step 3 Click Create. Set the link information for the GMPLS UNI in the Create GMPLS UNI Link window. Set the following information:
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-203

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Board: 6-JL64 l Port: 1(SDH-1) l Local IP Address: 129.0.0.13 l Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0 l Remote Router ID: 1.1.1.16 l Remote IP Address: 129.0.0.16

Step 4 Click Apply. Step 5 Repeat Steps 1-4 to set the information about the GMPLS UNI link of NE3. ----End

1.16.7 Setting the Information About the OIF UNI Link


In the case of the OIF UNI, you need to set the information such as the transport network address (TNA).

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The OIF UNI must be configured. The ASON feature of the NEs is enabled.

Procedure
Step 1 Select NE1 in the Main Topology. Right-click and choose NE Explorer from the short-cut menu. Step 2 Click NE1 in the NE Explorer. Choose ASON > UNI Management > TNA Address Management from the Function Tree.
1-204 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 3 Click Create. Set the link information for the OIF UNI in the Create OIF UNI Link Address window. Set the following information: l Board: 5-JL64 l Port: 1(SDH-1) l TNA Address: 129.1.1.13

Step 4 Click Apply. Step 5 Repeat Steps 1-4 to set the information about the OIF UNI link of NE3. ----End

1.16.8 Querying UNI Services


You can query the detailed information about the services that UNI users create, by using the U2000.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > UNI Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the Filter window, select the domain, source NE, and sink NE according to the requirements. Click Filter.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-205

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

----End

1.16.9 Deleting UNI Services


You can manually delete the services that the UNI users create, by using the U2000.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The UNI services must be configured.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > UNI Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the Filter window, select the domain, source NE, and sink NE according to the requirements. Click Filter. Step 3 Select the service that needs to be deleted. Right-click and choose Deactivate from the shortcut menu.

Step 4 After the service is deactivated, a dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. Step 5 Select the service that is deactivated in Step 3. Right-click and choose Delete from the short-cut menu.
1-206 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 6 After the service is deleted, a dialog box is displayed, indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. ----End

1.17 Managing the OVPN Customers and OVPN Services


In the case of the OVPN, an ASON network is shared by multiple operators. When multiple operators need to share an ASON network, you can allocate different TE link resources for each operator. Each operator can use and manage its own TE link resources and ASON services. 1.17.1 Enabling OVPN Function of ASON NE The optical virtual private network (OVPN) function can be used only when the OVPN function is enabled for all the NEs in the ASON domain. The OVPN function of the ASON NEs is controlled through the license of the NMS. The OVPN function of the ASON NEs can be enabled only if the license of the NMS supports the OVPN function. 1.17.2 Creating NM User for OVPN Customer To ensure that each OVPN customer can manage its own resources and services, an independent NM user needs to be created for each OVPN customer. 1.17.3 Creating an OVPN Customer Before the resources are allocated for different OVPN customers, the corresponding OVPN customers need to be created on the NMS. 1.17.4 Allocating TE Links for OVPN Customers Each OVPN customer can use only the allocated TE links to create services. The timeslots in the TE links allocated for each OVPN customer should be planned properly according to the actual situations before the services are configured. 1.17.5 Creating OVPN Services The OVPN services may be diamond services, gold services, silver services, copper services, or iron services. 1.17.6 Querying the TE Link Resources of the OVPN Customers After the TE link resources are allocated for the OVPN customers, you can query the TE link resources of each OVPN customer.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-207

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1.17.7 Querying the Services of the OVPN Customers After the ASON services are created for the OVPN customers, you can query the ASON services of each OVPN customer.

1.17.1 Enabling OVPN Function of ASON NE


The optical virtual private network (OVPN) function can be used only when the OVPN function is enabled for all the NEs in the ASON domain. The OVPN function of the ASON NEs is controlled through the license of the NMS. The OVPN function of the ASON NEs can be enabled only if the license of the NMS supports the OVPN function.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The license of the NMS must support the OVPN function.

CAUTION
The OVPN function must be enabled or disabled for all the ASON NEs in the ASON domain. Otherwise, the service creation may be affected.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the SDH ASON Topology Management window, select the domain for which the OVPN function needs to be enabled. Set OVPN Enable Status of all the NEs in this domain to Enabled.

Step 3 Click Apply. A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. ----End

1.17.2 Creating NM User for OVPN Customer


To ensure that each OVPN customer can manage its own resources and services, an independent NM user needs to be created for each OVPN customer.

Prerequisite
l l l
1-208

You must log in to the U2000 as the super user admin. The license of the NMS must support the OVPN function. The operation set and the object set must be created.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management
NOTE

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

To facilitate management, it is recommend that only one NM user is created for each OVPN client. For the OVPN working principles and authorities of the NM user, see 1.2.11 OVPN.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > NMS Security > NMS User Management from the main menu. Step 2 Create the NM user OVPN_NM_User1. 1. 2. 3. Choose User in the Security Management object tree. In the right pane, click New User. In the Details tab, enter the information of the new user. For example: l Name: OVPN_NM_User1 l Password: osninfo123 l Confirm password: osninfo123 l For the other parameters, adopt the default values.

4.

Click OK.

Step 3 Add the NM user OVPN_NM_User1 into Operator Group.


Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-209

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1. 2. 3. 4.

In the Security Management object tree, select the NM user OVPN_NM_User1. In the right pane, click the User Group tab. Click Add. Then, the Add User Group dialog box is displayed. Select Operator Group and click OK. The user group that is added is displayed in the User Groups list.

Step 4 Set the domain of the NM user. 1. 2. 3. 4. In the right pane, click the Domain tab. Click Select. Then, the Select Domain dialog box is displayed. In the dialog box, select the object set managed by the NM user. For example, OVPN_NE_user1 Click OK. The object set that is added is displayed in the Domain list. Step 5 Adjust the authority of the NM user OVPN_NM_User1. 1. 2. 3. 4. In the right pane, click the Operation Rights tab. Click Select. Then, the Select Rights dialog box is displayed. In the dialog box, select the operation set. For example, ASON E2E Operator Operation set. Click OK. The authorities that are added are displayed in the authority list. Step 6 Set the access control list of the NM user OVPN_NM_User1. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. In the right pane, click the ACL tab. Select the Use the current user ACL option box. Click Set ACL. Then, the ACL dialog box is displayed. Click Add. Then, the New System Access Control Item dialog box is displayed. Select the Start IP address - end IP address option box and set the following parameters. An example is provided as follows: l Start IP address: 192.168.0.1 l End IP address: 192.168.255.255 6. 7. 8. Click OK. Click Close. Select the Access Allowed check box that corresponds to the IP address range. Click Apply.

----End

1.17.3 Creating an OVPN Customer


Before the resources are allocated for different OVPN customers, the corresponding OVPN customers need to be created on the NMS.

Prerequisite
l
1-210

You must be an NM user with "NE administrator" authority or higher.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l l

The OVPN function must be enabled for the ASON NEs. The NM users of the OVPN customers must be created.

CAUTION
To facilitate management, it is recommended that each NM user should correspond to an OVPN customer.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Service > Customer Management from the main menu. Step 2 Optional: Create an OVPN customer group for conveniently managing OVPN customers. 1. 2. 3. 1. 2. Right-click the root object tree and choose Create Group from the shortcut menu. In the dialog box that is displayed, enter a name in the Group Name field. For example, OVPN Group. Click OK. In the Object Tree, select OVPN Group and click Create in the lower right portion of the window. In the dialog box that is displayed, enter the customer name, OVPN ID, and other information. For example, OVPNuser1 and 1100.

Step 3 Create OVPN customer that belongs to the OVPN customer group.

NOTE

l The OVPN ID ranges from 1 to 60000. l When you select Automatch OVPN ID, the system automatically allocates an OVPN ID to the customer.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-211

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3.

Click OK, create the OVPN customer successfully.

Step 4 Set the authority of the NM user to the OVPN customers.


NOTE

An NM user can manage multiple OVPN customers resources and services. An OVPN customer can be managed by multiple NM users.

1. 2. 3.

Select OVPN Group in the object tree in the left of the windows, choose OVPNuser1 in the right list, right-click, select Authorize to User. In the Customer Authorize Management windows, choose the Available Users. For example, OVPN_NM_User1. Click OK to complete the setting.

----End

1.17.4 Allocating TE Links for OVPN Customers


Each OVPN customer can use only the allocated TE links to create services. The timeslots in the TE links allocated for each OVPN customer should be planned properly according to the actual situations before the services are configured.

Prerequisite
l l l l You must log in to the U2000 as user admin. The OVPN function must be enabled for the ASON NEs. The OVPN customers must be created on the NMS. The timeslots in the TE links that are allocated for each OVPN customer must be planned properly.
NOTE

When you partition the TE links on the MSP ring for OVPN customers, ensure that the timeslots of each section are consistent.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the TE Link window, select the TE link that needs to be partitioned. Click Partition Resource.
TIP

You can select multiple TE links to be partitioned, by holding down the Ctrl key and clicking the target TE links.

Step 3 In the Partition Resource window, select the TE link that needs to be partitioned. Double-click OVPN Customer that corresponds to the specific timeslot and set the OVPN customer.

1-212

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Step 4 Click Apply. A dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Step 5 Optional: After the TE link resources are allocated, select a TE link and right-click Copy. Step 6 Optional: Select another TE link to copy the previously selected TE link to. Right-click and choose Paste from the shortcut menu. Step 7 Then, a dialog box is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Close the window. Step 8 Optional: Click Synchronize and select a TE link. Then, you can check the TE link allocation in the OVPN Customer Information window on the lower left. ----End

1.17.5 Creating OVPN Services


The OVPN services may be diamond services, gold services, silver services, copper services, or iron services.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The TE link resources must be allocated for the OVPN customers. There must be NM users who use the OVPN resources.

Service Requirements
As shown in Figure 1-97, the four NEs are ASON NEs. A 155 Mbit/s OVPN silver service needs to be configured for the OVPN1 customer between NE1 and NE3.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-213

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Figure 1-97 OVPN service requirements


NE1

NE2

NE4

NE3

ASON NE LSP

Board Configuration
According to the service requirements, the NEs can be configured with the boards as shown in Figure 1-98. Figure 1-98 Board configuration of NE1 and NE3

Service Planning
The OVPN services are planned according to the service requirements. Table 1-58 provides the service planning information.

1-214

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Table 1-58 OVPN service planning Attribute Source NE Source board-port Source timeslot Sink NE Sink board-port Sink timeslot Protection class OVPN customer SNCP access Route constraint Rerouting attribute Revertive Mode Rerouting policy NE1<->NE3 NE1 13-SLQ1-3 1 NE3 13-SLQ1-3 1 Silver OVPN1 None The service route must pass NE2. Automatically Revertive Use existing trails whenever possible

NOTE

Before you create the OVPN services, ensure that the TE link resources are already allocated for the OVPN customers.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose Create > ASON Trail, and the creation wizard is displayed. Step 3 In Basic information, enter the basic information of the ASON trail. For example, enter the following attributes: l Name: NE1-NE3-ASON-Trail-0003 l Type: ASON Trail l Class: Silver l Concatenation Type: Non-Concatenation l OVPN Customer: OVPN1 Step 4 In the Routing Attributes field, enter the rerouting attributes of the trail. For example, enter the following attributes: l Revetrive Mode: Revertive (Select Non-Revetrive if the silver service is a non-revertive service. Select Scheduled revertive if the silver service is a scheduled revertive service.) l Priority: 2
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-215

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

l Lockout: Unlocked l WTR Time(s): 600 l Policy: Use existing trail whenever possible Step 5 Set the source NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. For example, select the 7-N2SL64-1. Step 6 Set the sink NE. In the right-hand topology, double-click the sink NE and select a slot, port and timeslot from the dialog box displayed. Click OK. Step 7 Optional: Click Pre-Calculate to pre-calculate the route. Click the Pre-Calculate Route tab to view the related route information.
NOTE

If you check the Automatic Pre-Calculate check box, the U2000 issues a command for the NE to perform the automatic pre-calculation. Every change of the route constraints, the source/sink, or the protection type triggers an automatic pre-calculation.

Step 8 Select the Activate check box to deliver the created trails to the NE side, thus ensuring that the trails are in the Activate state. Step 9 Verify that the trail information and route restrictions are correctly entered. Click Apply. If the creation is successful, the system prompts that the operation was successful.
NOTE

To change the route restriction, select one or multiple route restrictions from the Route Restriction pane, right-click and choose Delete from the shortcut menu. The selected route constraint is deleted. Repeat Steps 8 through 10 to set new route constraints.

Step 10 Click Close. If the system prompts that the route calculation fails, check whether the route constraints are proper and whether the link resources are sufficient. Then start the configuration again from Step 1. Step 11 Click Cancel to go back to the SDH ASON Trail Management window. You can see the detailed descriptions of the service. ----End

1.17.6 Querying the TE Link Resources of the OVPN Customers


After the TE link resources are allocated for the OVPN customers, you can query the TE link resources of each OVPN customer.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The TE link resources must be allocated for the OVPN customers.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click Filter. Enter the filtering information in the Filter dialog box. An example is provided as follows: l Domain: ASON
1-216 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

l Source NE: All l Sink NE: All l OVPN Customer: OVPN1

Step 3 Click Filter. Then, the NMS returns the information about the queried TE link resources of the OVPN customer. ----End

1.17.7 Querying the Services of the OVPN Customers


After the ASON services are created for the OVPN customers, you can query the ASON services of each OVPN customer.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. The ASON services must be created for the OVPN customers.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Click Filter. In the Filter dialog box, select Select OVPN Customer. Step 3 Select the OVPN customer whose ASON services need to be queried. Click OK.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-217

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 4 In the Filter dialog box, click Filter All. Click Yes in the dialog box that is displayed. Step 5 The NMS returns the query result. ----End

1.18 Importing and Exporting Data


The existing ASON network may not be optimum, so we can use the OptiX Modeling and Design System (MDS) to optimize the network. You can import the ASON data on the U2000 to the MDS, and use the MDS to plan the imported ASON data and work out the optimum solution. You can import a better planning scheme to the U2000. Then, use the U2000 to apply the settings to NEs to optimize the existing ASON network. 1.18.1 Exporting Data from U2000 to MDS You can export ASON data from the U2000 to the MDS, and use the MDS to plan the existing ASON network according to the imported data. 1.18.2 Importing Data from MDS to U2000 You can use the MDS to plan ASON data, import the data from the MDS to the U2000, and then use the U2000 to optimize the existing ASON network.

1.18.1 Exporting Data from U2000 to MDS


You can export ASON data from the U2000 to the MDS, and use the MDS to plan the existing ASON network according to the imported data.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded to the U2000. The license of the U2000 supports exporting data to the MDS.

1-218

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > Back Up/Restore NMS Data > Import/Export Script File from the main menu. The Import/Export Script File window is displayed. Step 2 Select TXT as the script format and select Network Modeling and Design Information File from the Script File Type drop-down list.
NOTE

The interaction files with the MDS is the txt script file.

Step 3 Select Export. Step 4 Click Create File Directory and the Input window is displayed. Enter the directory name. Step 5 Click OK and the new directory name appears in the Default File Directory in the Operation Directory List. Step 6 Click Apply and click OK in the Confirm dialog box. Step 7 A progress bar is displayed and a prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. The directory where the script files reside is displayed. Step 8 Click Close. ----End

1.18.2 Importing Data from MDS to U2000


You can use the MDS to plan ASON data, import the data from the MDS to the U2000, and then use the U2000 to optimize the existing ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l l l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. ASON NEs must be created and the NEs data must be uploaded to the U2000. The license of the U2000 supports importing data from the MDS. Before the import, the U2000 database must not be initialized. The ASON information about the basic attributes and links of the U2000 before the data import to the U2000 must be the same as those before the data export to the MDS.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > Back Up/Restore NMS Data > Import/Export Script File from the main menu. The Import/Export Script File window is displayed. Step 2 Select TXT as the script format and select Network Modeling and Design Information File from the Script File Type drop-down list.
NOTE

The interaction files with the MDS is the txt script file.

Step 3 Select Import. Step 4 Click Refresh File Directory to keep the script file directory in the U2000 synchronized with the directory in the MDS.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-219

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 5 Select the directory in the Default File Directory in the Operation Directory List. Step 6 In the Import File List, select the desired file. Step 7 Click Apply and the Confirm dialog boxes are displayed. Follow the instructions as prompted and then click OK. Step 8 A progress bar is displayed and a prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Step 9 Click Close and the Select an Option dialog box is displayed. Step 10 Select ASON Trail Information in SDH DOMAIN and click OK. Step 11 A progress bar is displayed and a prompt is displayed indicating that the operation is successful. Click Close. ----End

1.19 Managing Control Plane Alarms and Performance Events


Users can suppress the control plane alarms, monitor the control plane performance, set the autoreport status of the control plane performance, and set the control plane performance threshold based on actual requirements. 1.19.1 Querying Control Plane Alarms For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms that specified trails generate on the control plane, to learn whether there are any faults on the control plane. 1.19.2 Setting the Severity of Control Plane Alarm The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can set the severity of the control plane alarms as required. 1.19.3 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Alarm The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can set the auto report status of the control plane alarms as required. 1.19.4 Suppressing Control Plane Alarms The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can suppress the specific control plane alarms as required. 1.19.5 Suppressing Control Plane Alarm Events Users can suppress control plane alarms at the service layer if required. 1.19.6 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane Users can view the current and history performance data of the control plane. In this manner, users can monitor the performance of the ASON Trail. 1.19.7 Monitoring the Control Plane Performance The control plane performance monitoring involves SDH ASON NE performance monitoring, SDH ASON trail performance monitoring, SDH ASON TE Link performance monitoring and control channel performance monitoring. The control plane performance monitor status defaults to be disabled. Users can enable the monitoring function if required so that they can discover and handle problems at the earliest time.
1-220 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

1.19.8 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Performance Data The control plane performance is monitored on a 24-hour basis. The performance is not reported automatically by default. Users can enable the auto-report function if required. The control plane performance monitoring involves SDH ASON NE performance monitoring, SDH ASON trail performance monitoring, SDH ASON TE Link performance monitoring, and control channel performance monitoring. 1.19.9 Setting the Control Plane Performance Threshold When an NE detects that a certain performance value exceeds the specified threshold, the NE reports a performance threshold crossing event. Set the performance threshold for every SDH ASON trail properly based on the requirements. In this way, the performance of every SDH ASON trail trail can be monitored.

1.19.1 Querying Control Plane Alarms


For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms that specified trails generate on the control plane, to learn whether there are any faults on the control plane.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 To query networkwide alarms, see 2.2.2 Querying Network-Wide Alarms. In the window for viewing the current alarms, click Filter.
NOTE

You can choose other navigation path. Choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the main menu.

Step 2 In the Filter dialog box displayed, select Alarm Name check box. Click Alarm dialog box displayed. Step 3 In the option alarm tree, select Control Plane Alarms, click plane alarms, click OK.

, the Select

, select all of the control

Step 4 Click OK. The alarms generated on the control plane are then displayed in the alarm list. ----End

1.19.2 Setting the Severity of Control Plane Alarm


The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can set the severity of the control plane alarms as required.

Prerequisite
l l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-221

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Context
This section considers suppressing the NE alarms as an example to describe how to set the severity of control plane alarms.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Alarm > Alarm Suppression and Severity. Step 2 Click NE Alarm Suppression and Severity tab. Step 3 Event names, suppress status and severity displays in the right windows. Step 4 Select the required event, double-click Severity, and then choose Critical from the drop-down menu. Step 5 Click Default, set the severity of alarm to the default value. Step 6 Optional: After the operation is complete, click Query to view the severity of the current alarms. ----End

1.19.3 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Alarm


The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can set the auto report status of the control plane alarms as required.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Alarm > Alarm Auto Reporting. Step 2 Event names and corresponding auto reporting status displays in the right windows. Step 3 Select the required event, double-click Auto Reporting Status, and then choose Reported from the drop-down menu. Step 4 Click Apply to submit the alarm suppression setting. Step 5 Optional: Click Default, set the auto report status of alarm to the default value. Step 6 Optional: After the operation is complete, click Query to view the suppression status of the current alarms. ----End

1.19.4 Suppressing Control Plane Alarms


The control plane alarms consist of NE alarm, ASON trail alarm, TE link alarm, control link alarm, and control channel alarm. Users can suppress the specific control plane alarms as required.
1-222 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

Context
This section considers suppressing the NE alarms as an example to describe how to suppress control plane alarms.

Procedure
Step 1 In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Alarm Suppression > NE Alarm Suppression Step 2 Event names and corresponding suppression status displays in the right windows. Step 3 Double-click Suppression Status, and then choose Suppressed from the drop-down menu.
NOTE

In the case of OptiX OSN 9560, choose Status.

Step 4 Click Apply to submit the alarm suppression setting. Step 5 Optional: After the operation is complete, click Query to view the suppression status of the current alarms. ----End

1.19.5 Suppressing Control Plane Alarm Events


Users can suppress control plane alarms at the service layer if required.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 Choose an ASON trail from the list, click Alarm and then select Control Plane Alarm Suppression. Step 3 Double click Suppression Status in the ASON Trail Alarm Suppression interface, and then choose Suppressed from the drop-down menu. Step 4 Click Apply to activate the alarm suppression setting. Step 5 Click Query to query the control plane alarm suppression status of the SDH ASON trail. ----End

1.19.6 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane


Users can view the current and history performance data of the control plane. In this manner, users can monitor the performance of the ASON Trail.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-223

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded. The NE Performance Monitoring Time is enabled.

Procedure
l Query the data on a network basis. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Choose Performance > Browse Control Plane Performance from the main menu. Click Current Performance Data tab to view the current performance data. Optional: Click History Performance Data tab to view the history performance data. Optional: Click Performance Threshold-Crossing Record tab to view the data of the performance threshold crossing events. Optional: Click Filter by Template and select Open from the drop-down list. In the Open dialog box, select a template for filtering performance data and click Open. Certain performance events are filtered and you can view the performance.
NOTE

The performance filtering template is already saved.

6. l 1.

Click Query. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Current Performance from the Function Tree to view the current performance data. Optional: Choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > History Performance from the Function Tree to view the history performance data. Optional: Click Filter by Template and select Open from the drop-down list. In the Open dialog box, select a template for filtering performance data and click Open. Certain performance events are filtered and you can view the performance.
NOTE

Query the data on a station basis.

2. 3.

The performance filtering template is already saved.

4. ----End

Click Query.

1.19.7 Monitoring the Control Plane Performance


The control plane performance monitoring involves SDH ASON NE performance monitoring, SDH ASON trail performance monitoring, SDH ASON TE Link performance monitoring and control channel performance monitoring. The control plane performance monitor status defaults to be disabled. Users can enable the monitoring function if required so that they can discover and handle problems at the earliest time.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

This section considers enabling the NE monitoring function as an example to describe how to enable or disable monitoring of the control plane performance.
1-224 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

Procedure
l In the case of NG SDH and OCS series equipment. 1. 2. 3. 4. l 1. 2. 3. 4. ----End In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Monitor Status. Click the SDH ASON NE tab. Double-click Monitoring Status of the required performance event, and then choose Enabled from the drop-down menu. Click Apply to submit the setting. Optional: Click Query to view the control plane monitoring status of ASON NE. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Performance Monitor Status. Click the NE Performance Monitor Status tab. Double-click Monitor Status of the required performance event, and then choose Enabled from the drop-down menu. Click Apply to submit the setting. Optional: Click Query to view the control plane monitoring status of ASON NE.

In the case of OptiX OSN 9560.

1.19.8 Setting the Auto-Report Status of the Control Plane Performance Data
The control plane performance is monitored on a 24-hour basis. The performance is not reported automatically by default. Users can enable the auto-report function if required. The control plane performance monitoring involves SDH ASON NE performance monitoring, SDH ASON trail performance monitoring, SDH ASON TE Link performance monitoring, and control channel performance monitoring.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

This section considers enabling the auto-report function as an example to describe how to enable or disable auto report of the control plane performance data.

Procedure
l In the case of NG SDH and OCS series equipment. 1. 2. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Auto-Reporting Status. options. Click the SDH ASON NE tab. Double-click Auto-Reporting Status of the required performance event, and then choose Enabled from the drop-down menu.

3.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Click Apply to submit the setting.


Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 1-225

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

4. l

Optional: Click Query to view the auto-report status of the control plane of the ASON NE. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Performance Monitor Status. Click the NE Performance Monitor Status tab. Double-click 24-Hour AutoReport of the required performance event, and then choose Enabled from the dropdown menu.

In the case of OptiX OSN 9560. 1. 2.

3. 4. ----End

Click Apply to submit the setting. Optional: Click Query to view the auto-report status of the control plane of the ASON NE.

1.19.9 Setting the Control Plane Performance Threshold


When an NE detects that a certain performance value exceeds the specified threshold, the NE reports a performance threshold crossing event. Set the performance threshold for every SDH ASON trail properly based on the requirements. In this way, the performance of every SDH ASON trail trail can be monitored.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE operator" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded.

Procedure
l In the case of NG SDH and OCS series equipment. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. l In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Performance Threshold. In the SDH ASON Trail list on the interface, select the desired SDH ASON trail. In the list, double-click the Threshold Value field of the SDH ASON trail, and then enter a new performance threshold value. Click Apply to submit the setting. Optional: Click Query to query the control plane performance threshold of the SDH ASON trail. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > SDH Performance Threshold. In the SDH ASON Trail list on the interface, select the desired SDH ASON trail.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

In the case of OptiX OSN 9560. 1. 2.

1-226

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

1 Configuring SDH ASON Networks

3. 4. 5. ----End

In the list, double-click the Threshold Value field of the SDH ASON trail, and then enter a new performance threshold value. Click Apply to submit the setting. Optional: Click Query to query the control plane performance threshold of the SDH ASON trail.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

1-227

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

About This Chapter


The routine maintenance for an ASON network involves service monitoring and resource monitoring. Service monitoring enables maintenance personnel to determine the affected scope at the earliest time when a fault occurs on the network. Then, the maintenance personnel can determine the rectification measures based on the characteristics of the fault and the current service status. In this manner, the maintenance personnel can determine the health status of the services promptly and minimize the impact on the services. Resource monitoring enables maintenance personnel eliminate potential faults on the network in real time and thus eliminate the severe potential risks in routine maintenance. Rectifying the resource anomalies in real time can help to improve the network resources utilization rate, promote the service survivability, discover the bottleneck of the network resources in advance, take capacity expansion measures promptly, and ensure healthy operation of the network all the time. This chapter focuses on the routine maintenance of the ASON control plane. For the routine maintenance of the transport plane, refer to the following documents. l l l l l l OptiX OSN 9500 Intelligent Optical Switching System Routine Maintenance OptiX OSN 7500 Intelligent Optical Switching System Routine Maintenance OptiX OSN 3500 Intelligent Optical Transmission System Routine Maintenance OptiX OSN 3500 II Intelligent Optical Transmission System Routine Maintenance OptiX OSN 2500 Intelligent Optical Transmission System Routine Maintenance OptiX OSN 1500 Intelligent Optical Transmission System Routine Maintenance

2.1 Precautions for Routine Maintenance The precautions for routine maintenance of an ASON network are described. 2.2 Routine Maintenance Items The normal running of an ASON network depends on effective routine maintenance. The purpose of routine maintenance is to find and solve problems in time.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-1

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2.1 Precautions for Routine Maintenance


The precautions for routine maintenance of an ASON network are described.

Switching off Laser


Before switching off the laser at an optical port with an ASON service, transfer the ASON service to another trail. If the optical port has no service, lock the ASON trail that pass the optical port by setting the Rerouting Lockout attribute of the trail to Locked.

CAUTION
Do not frequently switch on or switch off the laser at an optical port that has a TE link.

Looping Back Optical Port


When fiber jumpers are used to loopback an optical port that has ASON services, first transfer the ASON services to other ASON trails. If the optical port has no services, lock out the ASON trails that pass the optical port by setting the Rerouting Lockout attribute of the trails to Locked.

Inserting or Removing Fibers


Before inserting or removing fibers at an optical port with ASON services, transfer the ASON services to other trails. If the optical port has no actual services, lock the ASON trails that pass the optical port by setting the Rerouting Lockout attribute of the trails to Locked.

CAUTION
l Do not frequently insert or remove fibers at an optical port that has TE links. l Do not remove or insert fibers on an optical port with services running.

Replacing and Resetting the SCC Board


The ASON software runs on the SCC board and saves network data in real time. Hence, the NE cannot run normally if the SCC board is absent for a long time. Before you replace an SCC board, make sure that there is no rerouting or any other manual operation on ASON services. Do not reset the SCC board when there are ASON services being created, deleted, or rerouted.

CAUTION
Do not reset the SCC board when there are ASON services being created, deleted, or rerouted.

2-2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

Precautions for Maintaining the U2000 System


Do not exit the U2000 when it is normally running, though this operation does not interrupt the network services. When the U2000 is shut down, however, it cannot monitor the ASON software and the continuity for monitoring the ASON software is affected. You also need to make sure that the U2000 computer is secure and not damaged.

2.2 Routine Maintenance Items


The normal running of an ASON network depends on effective routine maintenance. The purpose of routine maintenance is to find and solve problems in time. 2.2.1 Periodically Refreshing the ASON information Every time an ASON NE is rerouted, the service route and link information change. You need to periodically refresh the ASON information to keep consistency between the data on the U2000 and the data on the NE. 2.2.2 Querying Network-Wide Alarms You can query the NE alarms in the entire network to find abnormal alarms timely. 2.2.3 Querying ASON Trail Alarms For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a specified ASON trail to learn the failures of an ASON network. 2.2.4 Querying Control Plane Alarms For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms that specified trails generate on the control plane, to learn whether there are any faults on the control plane. 2.2.5 Querying Control Link Alarms For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a control link, to learn whether the control link is faulty. 2.2.6 Querying TE Link Alarms For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a TE link to learn the failures of an ASON network. 2.2.7 Creating a Performance Filtering Template By creating and modifying performance filtering template, a network maintainer can quickly view the specific performance events of specific NEs when the maintainer enables the performance monitoring next time. 2.2.8 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane Users can view the current and history performance data of the control plane. In this manner, users can monitor the performance of the ASON Trail. 2.2.9 Querying Abnormal ASON Events During routine maintenance, you need to query abnormal events to check the running status of the network. 2.2.10 Checking the Running Status of ASON Trails During routine maintenance, you must periodically check the running status of ASON trails to check whether the trail attributes are changed and to ensure the normal running of the trails. 2.2.11 Checking TE Links During routine maintenance, you need to know the resource utilizations of TE links. First, check the number of TE links in the entire network. Then, check the remaining resources of each TE
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2-3

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

link. The number of TE links should be consistent with the number of TE links that are actually used. The remaining resources of the TE links on two adjacent nodes on one fiber should be the same. 2.2.12 Checking Control Links During routine maintenance, you need to check the number and status of control links. 2.2.13 Checking the Activation Status of ASON Services The activation status of ASON services should be periodically checked to ensure the normal running of ASON services.

2.2.1 Periodically Refreshing the ASON information


Every time an ASON NE is rerouted, the service route and link information change. You need to periodically refresh the ASON information to keep consistency between the data on the U2000 and the data on the NE.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE maintainer" authority or higher.

Background Information
You can choose the information that you want to refresh periodically, which includes TE link information, ASON trail status, and ASON trail route information. The ASON trail status includes ASON trail channel status, SLA compliant, rerouting attributes, information of associated services, and information of preset restoration trail.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Administration > Task Schedule > Task Management from the main menu. Step 2 Create a task to periodically refresh the ASON information. 1. 2. 3. 4. Click New and the New Task is displayed. Set the task type to Refresh ASON Information, select the Run Type and enter the task name. Click Next. Set the Time Setting or the Period Setting. Click Next. Select the information that you want to refresh periodically and click Finish. A scheduled task is successfully created.

Step 3 Select the task whose Task Type is Refresh ASON Information. Step 4 Select the Run At Once in the shortcut menu. And you can view the parameters in the list to know the running status. Step 5 Optional: Double-click the scheduled task to modify the parameters of the task. ----End

2.2.2 Querying Network-Wide Alarms


You can query the NE alarms in the entire network to find abnormal alarms timely.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.
2-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

Background Information
l l The numeral on the right of the indicator indicates the number of current critical alarms in the entire network. If there is a block outside the circle that indicates the alarm indicator, the alarm is not acknowledged.

Procedure
Step 1 Click (red) at the upper right of the U2000 user interface to view the network-wide critical alarms. The Networkwide Critical Alarm window is displayed. The critical alarms that require high attention include the following: l R_LOS l R_LOF l EXT_SYNC_LOS l HARD_BAD l SUBCARD_ABN l NESTATE_INSTALL
NOTE

It is recommended to keep this window open during alarm monitoring.

Step 2 Click (orange) at the upper right of the U2000 user interface to view the networkwide major alarms. The major alarms that require high attention include the following: l MS_AIS, TU_AIS l B2_EXC, B3_EXC l POWER_ABNORMAL l APS_INDI l TEMP_OVER l TPS_ALM (yellow) at the upper right of the U2000 user interface to view the networkwide Step 3 Click minor alarms. The minor alarms that require high attention include the following: l B1_EXC, B1_SD, B2_SD, B3_SD l MS_RDI, HP_RDI l J0_MM Step 4 Optional: Right-click an ASON-related alarm and choose Alarm-Affected Original Route from the shortcut menu. In the SDH ASON Trail Management window displayed, you can view the detailed information of the affected original route. ----End

2.2.3 Querying ASON Trail Alarms


For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a specified ASON trail to learn the failures of an ASON network.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2-5

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. An ASON trail must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the trail list, select an ASON trail and click Alarms. Choose Current Alarms from the dropdown menu. The current alarms of the ASON trial are displayed in a new window. Step 3 Optional: In the trail list, select an ASON trail and click Alarms. Choose History Alarms from the drop-down menu. The history alarms of the ASON trail are displayed in a new window. Step 4 Optional: Right-click an ASON-related alarm and choose Browse Alarm-Affected Original Route from the shortcut menu. In the SDH ASON Trail Management window displayed, you can view the information of the affected original route. Step 5 Optional: Right-click an alarm related to an ASON trail, and choose Browse Alarm-Affected ASON Trail from the shortcut menu. In the SDH ASON Trail Management window displayed, you can view the information of the affected ASON trail.
NOTE

When you right-click an alarm, the Browse Alarm-Affected ASON Trail shortcut menu item is available only if the alarm affects an SDH ASON trail.

Step 6 Optional: Right-click an alarm related to a TE link, and choose Browse Alarm-Affected TE Link from the shortcut menu. In the SDH TE Link Management window displayed, you can view the information of the affected TE link.
NOTE

When you right-click an alarm, the Browse Alarm-Affected TE Link shortcut menu item is available only if the alarm affects a TE link.

----End

2.2.4 Querying Control Plane Alarms


For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms that specified trails generate on the control plane, to learn whether there are any faults on the control plane.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 To query networkwide alarms, see 2.2.2 Querying Network-Wide Alarms. In the window for viewing the current alarms, click Filter.
NOTE

You can choose other navigation path. Choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the main menu.

2-6

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

Step 2 In the Filter dialog box displayed, select Alarm Name check box. Click Alarm dialog box displayed. Step 3 In the option alarm tree, select Control Plane Alarms, click plane alarms, click OK.

, the Select

, select all of the control

Step 4 Click OK. The alarms generated on the control plane are then displayed in the alarm list. ----End

2.2.5 Querying Control Link Alarms


For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a control link, to learn whether the control link is faulty.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Control Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the control link list, select a control link and click Alarms. Choose Current Alarms from the drop-down menu. The currents alarms of the control link are then displayed in a new window. Step 3 Optional: In the control link list, select a control link and click Alarms. Choose History Alarms from the drop-down menu. The history alarms of the control link are then displayed in a new window. ----End

2.2.6 Querying TE Link Alarms


For maintenance purposes, you can query the current alarms or history alarms of a TE link to learn the failures of an ASON network.

Prerequisite
l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. A TE link must be created.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Step 2 In the link list, select a TE link and click Alarms. Choose Current Alarms from the drop-down menu. Step 3 Optional: In the link list, select a TE link and click Alarms. Choose History Alarms from the drop-down menu. Step 4 The current alarms of the TE link are displayed in a new window.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2-7

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

If you choose History Alarms from the drop-down menu, the history alarms of the TE link are displayed. ----End

2.2.7 Creating a Performance Filtering Template


By creating and modifying performance filtering template, a network maintainer can quickly view the specific performance events of specific NEs when the maintainer enables the performance monitoring next time.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Context
The Filter by Template function involves the following windows: viewing the SDH performance, viewing the WDM performance, and viewing the control panel performance.

Procedure
Step 1 In the Object Tree on the left of the window for viewing performance, select one or more NEs or boards on NEs. In filter criteria area of the table on the right of the window, set parameters for filtering performance events. Step 2 On the lower portion of the window for viewing performance, click Filter by Template and select Save. from the drop-down list. Step 3 In the Enter the Name dialog box, enter the template name and click OK.
NOTE

l After the template is saved, the name of the current template is displayed next to the window title. l When you save the template, the filtering parameters in only the current window are saved. l When you modify the original template, select Save from the drop-down list. The template needs not to be renamed.

----End

2.2.8 Querying the Performance of the Control Plane


Users can view the current and history performance data of the control plane. In this manner, users can monitor the performance of the ASON Trail.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher. An ASON NE must be created and the NE data must be uploaded. The NE Performance Monitoring Time is enabled.

Procedure
l Query the data on a network basis. 1.
2-8

Choose Performance > Browse Control Plane Performance from the main menu.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

2. 3. 4. 5.

Click Current Performance Data tab to view the current performance data. Optional: Click History Performance Data tab to view the history performance data. Optional: Click Performance Threshold-Crossing Record tab to view the data of the performance threshold crossing events. Optional: Click Filter by Template and select Open from the drop-down list. In the Open dialog box, select a template for filtering performance data and click Open. Certain performance events are filtered and you can view the performance.
NOTE

The performance filtering template is already saved.

6. l 1.

Click Query. In the NE Explorer, click the NE and then choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > Current Performance from the Function Tree to view the current performance data. Optional: Choose ASON > Control Plane Performance > History Performance from the Function Tree to view the history performance data. Optional: Click Filter by Template and select Open from the drop-down list. In the Open dialog box, select a template for filtering performance data and click Open. Certain performance events are filtered and you can view the performance.
NOTE

Query the data on a station basis.

2. 3.

The performance filtering template is already saved.

4. ----End

Click Query.

2.2.9 Querying Abnormal ASON Events


During routine maintenance, you need to query abnormal events to check the running status of the network.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Background Information
The following events require high attention: l l l l l l Failed iron trial restoration event ASON trail deletion event on failed restoration. Failed ASON trial restoration event ASON trail rerouting event ASON trial downgrade event Control channel down event

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-9

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

CAUTION
Viewing abnormal events is important for maintaining an ASON network. Hence, view abnormal events periodically.

Procedure
Step 1 Click Fault > Browse Event in the main manual, the Filter dialog box is displayed. Step 2 Select Basic Settings tab in the Filter dialog box, set the Event name, Severity, Type and Generated Time of the desired events, you can also enter the remarks contained by the events if necessary.
NOTE

Check the Event name check box, click the Select Event dialog box, select the events desired.

behind the Event name textbox, in the displayed

Step 3 Click the Event Source tab, you can filter the events by object or by type. Step 4 Click OK, all of the records that fit the filter restriction is displayed. Step 5 Click Save as to save the records to the specified path. ----End

Result
The list displays the detailed information of some abnormal events. Table 2-1 Abnormal Events List Item Failed ASON Trail Restoration Event ASON Trail Deletion Event upon Failed Restoration Failed Iron Service Restoration Event ASON Trail Rerouting Event Failed ASON Trail Rerouting Event Description The revertive ASON trail fails to revert. After the revertive ASON trail fails to revert, it is deleted. After MS switching, the iron service fails to be restored. The ASON trail reroutes. The ASON trail fails to reroute.

2.2.10 Checking the Running Status of ASON Trails


During routine maintenance, you must periodically check the running status of ASON trails to check whether the trail attributes are changed and to ensure the normal running of the trails.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.
2-10 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

Procedure
l Perform the following steps to check the running status of all ASON trails on the topology: 1. 2. 3. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. In the trail list, right-click the ASON trails that you want to view and choose Details from the shortcut menu. In the dialog box displayed, check the status of the selected ASON trails. Activation Status: Active is the normal status. Control Plane Alarm Status: If there is any alarm, handle it immediately.

4. l

Click OK.

Perform the following steps to check the running status of all ASON trails in the NE Explorer: 1. 2. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > ASON Trail from the Function Tree. Select a query mode in Query ASON Trail.
NOTE

There are four query modes, which are With this node as source, With this node as the intermediate node, With this node as sink, and Passing through this node.

3. ----End

Click Query.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

2-11

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2.2.11 Checking TE Links


During routine maintenance, you need to know the resource utilizations of TE links. First, check the number of TE links in the entire network. Then, check the remaining resources of each TE link. The number of TE links should be consistent with the number of TE links that are actually used. The remaining resources of the TE links on two adjacent nodes on one fiber should be the same.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
l Perform the following steps to check all the TE links on the topology: 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > TE Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. In the Synchronize dialog box displayed, choose Domain. Click Synchronize, the information in the list is refreshed. Refer to the Total at the bottom of the TE Link group box to learn the number of TE links. View the , Bandwidth Usage, and Downgrade Type of each TE link. Control Plane Alarm Status: If there is any alarm, handle it immediately. Bandwidth Usage: Displays the utilization of the bandwidth resources. The information is displayed in different colors according to the value of the Threshold field. Downgrade Type: Normal indicates that the TE link is not downgraded. 5. l Optional: You can view the Total Resource Usage of multiple links at the bottom of the TE Link group box. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > Link Management Protocol from the Function Tree. Click the LMP TE Link or LMP Component Link tab. Click Query.

Perform the following steps to view the LMP protocol status of TE links in the NE Explorer: 1. 2. 3.

Perform the following steps to view the OSPF protocol status of TE links in the NE Explorer: 1. 2. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > OSPF Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Click the OSPF TE Link or OSPF Component Link tab.
NOTE

For OptiX OSN 9560, the tabs is OSPF SDH TE link or OSPF Component Link.

3.

Optional: Select a desired unit in Bandwidth Units.


NOTE

There are four bandwidth units, which are VC4, VC3, VC12, and kbit/s.

4. ----End
2-12

Click Query.

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

2.2.12 Checking Control Links


During routine maintenance, you need to check the number and status of control links.

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
l Perform the following steps to query the status and number of control links in the entire network: 1. 2. 3. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Control Link Management from the main menu. Click Synchronize. The information in the list is refreshed. View the status of control links in the list. You can also view the number of control links in the entire network.

Perform the following steps to query the status of control links on a single NE: 1. 2. 3. In the NE Explorer, select an NE and choose ASON > OSPF Protocol Management from the Function Tree. Click the OSPF Control Link tab. To query the status and number of control links on the NE, click Query.

----End

2.2.13 Checking the Activation Status of ASON Services


The activation status of ASON services should be periodically checked to ensure the normal running of ASON services.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 2-13

2 Routine Maintenance for an ASON Network

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Prerequisite
You must be an NM user with "NE monitor" authority or higher.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. Click Filter in SDH ASON Trail Management. Step 2 Select Inactive from Filter to filter all the inactive ASON services. Step 3 If an inactive ASON service exists, perform the following steps. 1. 2. 3. In SDH ASON Trail Management, view the sink node of the service, and then delete the service. If the service exists in SDH Trail Management, delete the service. Open the NE Explorer of the sink node. Choose ASON > Advanced Maintenance from the Function Tree. Select the Query ASON Trail dropdown list in the ASON Signaling Maintenance tab. Select With this node as sink in the dropdown list, and then click Query to check view the inactive ASON service. Right-click the service to choose Downgrade ASON Signaling. Then, downgrade the service from the sink node, and thus the service is converted to a traditional service. Choose Service > SDH Trail > Search for SDH Trail from the main menu. Search the trail. The trail search is complete. Choose Service > SDH Trail > Manage SDH Trail from the main menu. View the searched traditional service. Right-click the service to choose Upgrade to ASON. Select the proper service attribute in the displayed Upgrade to ASON window, and then click OK. Thus, the upgrade is complete.

4. 5. 6.

----End

2-14

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

Handling ASON Network Failures

About This Chapter


By using the U2000, you can handle the common faults of an ASON network, such as the link fault, service creation failure, service interruption and NE database fault. 3.1 Handling Link Failures Link failure contains control channel failure, component link failure, and TE link failure. 3.2 Handling the Failure in Creating Trails Causes for the trail creation failure are various. 3.3 Handling Trail Interruption Causes for the trail interruption are various. 3.4 Disaster Recovery If the dual SCC boards of an NE becomes faulty, or the NE is in the installation status, or the database of the NE is lost, you can restore the data on the NE in the ASON NE recovery wizard.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-1

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3.1 Handling Link Failures


Link failure contains control channel failure, component link failure, and TE link failure. 3.1.1 Handling Impassable Control Channels Control channels are classified into control channels inside and outside fibers. The control channels inside fibers use D4-D12 bytes to transmit the check information. The control channels outside fibers are seldom used. 3.1.2 Handling Impassable Component Links Only when control channels between adjacent nodes are available in an ASON network, can component links be verified. 3.1.3 Handling Impassable TE Links Only when control channels between adjacent nodes are available in an ASON network can TE links be checked. 3.1.4 Handling Downgraded TE Links If a TE link is downgraded, it indicates that the status of the TE link is normal before.

3.1.1 Handling Impassable Control Channels


Control channels are classified into control channels inside and outside fibers. The control channels inside fibers use D4-D12 bytes to transmit the check information. The control channels outside fibers are seldom used.

Common Causes for Impassable Control Channels


Possible causes for impassable control channels are listed below. l l l l l l The opposite NE is a traditional NE. The LMP protocol of the optical interface is manually disabled. No DCC is allocated to the optical interface. The ECC is not passable because of bit errors. Alarms such as R_LOS or R_LOF are raised at the optical interface. The board is not in position.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the type of the opposite NE. If the opposite NE is a traditional NE, the control channel of the local NE is not passable. Step 2 Check the state of the LMP protocol at the optical interface. If the state of the protocol at the optical interface is Disabled, it indicates that the LMP protocol is manually disabled. Enable the LMP protocol at the optical interface again. Step 3 Check DCC state of the optical interface. If no DCC is allocated to the optical interface, shut down the DCC of the optical interface that does not require ECC communication.
NOTE

Only the DCC of the optical interface that does not require ECC communication can be shut down. Make sure that ECC communication is not necessary for the optical interface before shutting down the DCC.

3-2

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

Step 4 Check the bit errors of the optical interface. If there is any bit error, clear them. Step 5 Check the alarms at the optical interface. If there are alarms such as R_LOS and R_LOF, clear the alarms. Step 6 Check the state of the physical board. l l If the physical board is not in position, remove it and then insert it again. Add the logical board correctly. If the physical board is faulty, replace it.

Step 7 Disable LMP of the optical interfaces at the two ends of the control channel. Then enable LMP of the optical interfaces at the two ends of the control channel. ----End

3.1.2 Handling Impassable Component Links


Only when control channels between adjacent nodes are available in an ASON network, can component links be verified.

Common Causes for Impassable Component Links


Common causes for impassable component links are listed below. l l l Control channels are not passable. Logical boards are not added. Logical boards do not match physical boards.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the status of the control channel between the remote and local ends. If the control channel is not passable, troubleshoot the fault. Step 2 Check whether the logical boards and physical boards at the remote and local ends are consistent. If logical boards do not match physical boards, add new logical boards or replace the physical boards. ----End

3.1.3 Handling Impassable TE Links


Only when control channels between adjacent nodes are available in an ASON network can TE links be checked.

Common Causes for Impassable TE Links


Common causes for impassable TE links are listed as follows: l l l
Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Control channels are impassable. The board software does not match with the NE software. Physical fibers are improperly connected.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 3-3

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Procedure
Step 1 Check the status of the control channel between the remote and the local nodes. If the control channel is not passable, see 3.1.1 Handling Impassable Control Channels to rectify the fault on the control channel. Step 2 Check the NE software and the board software. According to the mapping table, find the board software that is mapped with the NE software. If the NE software does not match with the board software, load the board software again. Step 3 Check whether physical fibers are improperly connected. If the physical fibers are improperly connected, connect the fibers again. Step 4 When you upgrade a pass-through node to an ASON node, change all services that pass through the node to other trails and, on the sources and sinks of the services and on this node, disable and enable the LMP protocol. ----End

3.1.4 Handling Downgraded TE Links


If a TE link is downgraded, it indicates that the status of the TE link is normal before.

Common Causes for Downgraded TE Links


Common causes for downgraded TE links are listed as follows. l l The control channel is down. The communication between the NE software and the board software is abnormal.

Procedure
Step 1 Remove the fault of the control channel. Step 2 If you encounter the following problems, perform a soft reset on the SCC to remove the fault. l If you query from the SDH TE Link Management interface, the query result shows that the TE link is downgraded. l If you query from the NE Explorer interface, the query result shows that the TE link is not downgraded. ----End

3.2 Handling the Failure in Creating Trails


Causes for the trail creation failure are various. 3.2.1 Handling the Failure of Route Computation If the route computation fails during the ASON service creation, an error message is displayed on the U2000. 3.2.2 Handling the Failure to Allocate Labels If label allocation fails during ASON service creation, an error message is displayed on the U2000. 3.2.3 Handling the Failure in Creating Services in Batches
3-4 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

You can create ASON services in batches.

3.2.1 Handling the Failure of Route Computation


If the route computation fails during the ASON service creation, an error message is displayed on the U2000.

Common Causes for Route Computation


Common causes for the route computation are listed as follows. l The network resource is insufficient. When you create a diamond service, the non-protection resource of the TE link is not sufficient. When you create a gold service, the working and non-protection resources of the TE link are not sufficient. When you create a silver service, the non-protection resource of the TE link is not sufficient. When you create a copper service, the non-protection resource of the TE link is not sufficient. When you create an iron service, the protection and non-protection resources of the TE link are not sufficient. l The explicit links are not specified in a correct manner. When you create a diamond service, the explicit link has no non-protection resources. When you create a gold service, the explicit link only has protection resources. When you create a silver service, the explicit link has no non-protection resources. When you create a copper service, the explicit link has no non-protection resources. When you create an iron service, the explicit link only has working resources. l l The explicit timeslot has been reserved. The explicit nodes are not specified in a correct manner.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the CrankBack attempts. If the value of CrankBack is not 0, the system still returns a failure message after a rerouting is performed. It is recommended that you set the Crankback to 0. Step 2 Check the utilization of the network resource. If the network resource is not sufficient, add some resource and then create the ASON service. Step 3 Check the reservation state of the designated link. If the designated link does not have available resources, release the designated link. Step 4 Check the reservation of explicit timeslots. If an explicit timeslot is reserved, specify another explicit timeslot. Step 5 Check whether the explicit nodes are arranged in the expected sequence. If not, an error is reported. In this case, specify multiple explicit nodes in the sequence you want. Step 6 If the designated node does not have resources, release the designated node. ----End
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 3-5

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3.2.2 Handling the Failure to Allocate Labels


If label allocation fails during ASON service creation, an error message is displayed on the U2000.

Common Causes for the Failure to Allocate Labels


Common causes for the failure to allocate labels are listed below. l l The timeslot states are not consistent. The timeslot is reserved at a single end.

Procedure
Step 1 Synchronize the cross-connection of the NE. 1. 2. Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Trail Management from the main menu. The Filter dialog box is displayed. Click Filter All, Incremental Filter or Secondary Filter.
NOTE

l If you need to filter all the ASON trails, click Filter All. l If you need to add to the list more ASON trails that match the requirement, click Incremental Filter. l If you need to filter the ASON trails in the list, click Secondary Filter.

3.

Click Synchronize, in the Synchronize dialog box displayed, set the Domain and Attributes.
NOTE

l Attributes: basic information, working state, SLA-compliant, rerouting attributes and associated services. l You can also select one or more ASON trails, right-click and choose Synchronize from the shortcut menu to synchronize the selected ASON trails. At this time, the synchronized attributes for the ASON trails are consistent with the synchronization attributes that you set in the Synchronize window.

4.

Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > ASON Topology Management from the main menu. Select the ASON domain that requires synchronization of cross-connection of NEs. Right-click all these NEs and choose Synchronize NE Cross-Connection.

Step 2 Check the reservation of explicit timeslots. If an explicit timeslot is reserved, specify another explicit timeslot. ----End

3.2.3 Handling the Failure in Creating Services in Batches


You can create ASON services in batches.
3-6 Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

Common causes for the failure to create services in batch


The batch creation of services fail due to the following causes. l l l Sufficient resources are not available. The batch creation involves too many services. The previous batch creation or optimization of services is still in progress.

Procedure
Step 1 Check the network resources. l l If the network resources are not sufficient, create less number of services in a batch. If the network resources are sufficient, check if the previous batch creation of services is complete.

Step 2 After the previous batch service creation or the service optimization is complete, make another attempt to create the services in a batch. ----End

3.3 Handling Trail Interruption


Causes for the trail interruption are various. You must consider the following guidelines to troubleshoot trails interruption. 1. 2. 3. 4. Query alarms and check which trails are interrupted. Then record the information about the source and sink ports for the interrupted trails. Optimize the service trails to avoid the fault trails and restore the services. If the optimization fails , delete the service. You should re-create traditional SDH trails to avoid faulty trails and restore the trails. After services are restored, collect the related data to find out the cause and handle the fault.

3.3.1 Determining Interrupted Services You need to determine the interrupted services before restoring the services. 3.3.2 Troubleshooting Interruption of Services After determining the interrupted services, you can restore them.

3.3.1 Determining Interrupted Services


You need to determine the interrupted services before restoring the services.

Prerequisite
One or more services are interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Fault > Synchronize Networkwide Alarms from the main menu. Synchronize the network-wide alarms. Step 2 Choose Fault > Browse Current Alarm from the main menu.
Issue 02 (2010-09-24) Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. 3-7

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

Step 3 The dialog box is displayed, click OK, browse all of the alarms. Step 4 Search the CP_SER_IN alarm in these alarms. Step 5 Right-click the CP_SER_IN to choose Alarm-Affected ASON Trail. The SDH ASON Trail Management is displayed. Thus, check the interrupted ASON trails. ----End

3.3.2 Troubleshooting Interruption of Services


After determining the interrupted services, you can restore them.

Prerequisite
Services are interrupted.

Procedure
Step 1 In SDH ASON Trail Management, check Activation Status of the interrupted services. If the activation state is Inactive, do as follows: 1. 2. 3. Right-click the interrupted service to choose Deactivate. If the deactivation fails, proceed to the next step. Right-click the interrupted service to choose Force to Deactivate. Right-click the interrupted service to choose Activate. If the activation succeeds, the fault is rectified. If the activation fails, proceed to the next step. Select the interrupted service, and then click Maintenance to choose Optimize Route. Optimize this service to other trails. If the optimization succeeds, the fault is rectified. If the optimization fails, proceed to the next step. According to the recorded information on the faulty services, create the traditional SDH service for service restoration.

4.

Step 2 If the activation state of the interrupted service is Active, check whether the TE link is interrupted. If the TE link is interrupted, refer to 3.1.3 Handling Impassable TE Links for management. Otherwise, proceed to the next step. Step 3 Check whether the boards that used for adding and dropping this service are in position. If not, insert the boards well. ----End

3.4 Disaster Recovery


If the dual SCC boards of an NE becomes faulty, or the NE is in the installation status, or the database of the NE is lost, you can restore the data on the NE in the ASON NE recovery wizard.

Prerequisite
l l l You must be an NM user with "NM maintainer" authority or higher. Log in to the U2000 in single user mode. The hardware of the NE to be recovered is in the normal state, including dual control boards, faulty boards, and optical fiber connections. The settings such as NE ID, IP address, and ASON node ID must be the same as those before the fault occurs.
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

3-8

iManager U2000 Unified Network Management System Operation Guide for SDH ASON Network Management

3 Handling ASON Network Failures

The communication between the U2000 and the NE to be recovered, and the communication between the U2000 and the other ASON NEs in the ASON domain are in the normal state. The ASON feature at the NE side of the NE to be recovered is disabled. OptiX OSN 9560 cannot support disaster recovery.

l l

Precautions
When recovering the ASON trail, this wizard also recovers the traditional data, such as static service and the multiplex section. In this case, you do not need to download the NE data separately. l l l l l This function is applicable only to the fault recovery when a single SDH ASON NE database fails or the dual control boards fail, and the NE cannot start. The data that is not synchronized to the U2000 before the fault occurs cannot be recovered. Do not use this function on a normal NE. Otherwise, the NE or the service may become abnormal. All of the ASON NEs in the ASON domain to which the faulty NE belongs must support the function. Do not restart the U2000 after the NE failed, otherwise some data would not recover.

Procedure
Step 1 Choose Configuration > SDH ASON > Recover ASON NE from the main menu. Then, the ASON NE Recovery Wizard-Step dialog box is displayed. Step 2 Read the Function Description of the wizard carefully. Click Next. Step 3 Please select the NE to be recovered from the NE list, and then click Next. Step 4 Check whether the information of the NE to be restored is correct. If not, click back to modify the information. After you confirm that the information is correct, click Next. Step 5 After the NE data restoration is complete, the Prompt dialog box is displayed indicating that the data restoration is successful. Click OK. Step 6 Check for the restoration result. Certain services may fail to be restored. Restore these services manually. Click Close. Step 7 In the displayed Prompt dialog box, click OK.
NOTE

It is recommended that you synchronize the data of the entire network after the NE data is restored successfully.

----End

Issue 02 (2010-09-24)

Huawei Proprietary and Confidential Copyright Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd.

3-9

Das könnte Ihnen auch gefallen